67% found this document useful (3 votes)
1K views

Medrad Veris 8600

User manual medrad Veris 8600

Uploaded by

Andres Morales
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
67% found this document useful (3 votes)
1K views

Medrad Veris 8600

User manual medrad Veris 8600

Uploaded by

Andres Morales
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 228

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00.

The signed original is maintained in


Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Veris 8600
Vital Signs Monitor
TM

Operation Manual

3010796 Revision 2
Date 05/05

Page i

Veris 8600
Operation Manual

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

TM

Copyright 2005, MEDRAD Inc. All rights reserved.


Reproduction of this manual is strictly prohibited
without express written consent of MEDRAD, Inc.
For more information about MEDRAD products
and services, please visit www.medrad.com

Page ii

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Contents
Contents................................................................................................................ iii
In Case of Emergency Contact ............................................................................. xi
CE Contact ...................................................................................................... xi
MEDRAD Subsidiaries..................................................................................... xi
International Offices......................................................................................... xi
Symbols .............................................................................................................. xiii
Regulatory Symbols....................................................................................... xiii
Safety Symbols.............................................................................................. xiii
System Symbols ............................................................................................ xiv
Port Symbols ................................................................................................. xiv
Miscellaneous Symbols .................................................................................. xv
Safety .................................................................................................................. xvi
Definitions ...................................................................................................... xvi
Warnings........................................................................................................ xvi
Cautions....................................................................................................... xviii
Introduction ........................................................................................................ xxii
Description.................................................................................................... xxii
Intended Use ................................................................................................ xxii
Clinical Use.................................................................................................. xxiii

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Section 1 - Panel Features


Front Panel ................................................................................................................... 1-1
Menu Knob......................................................................................................... 1-2
Color Display...................................................................................................... 1-2
Water Trap and Gas Sampling Connection ....................................................... 1-2
Left Side Panel (Main Monitor) ..................................................................................... 1-3
Communication Port (Main Monitor) ............................................................................. 1-4
Main Monitor Base Connections ................................................................................... 1-5
Chassis Ground ................................................................................................. 1-5
DC Connection................................................................................................... 1-5
Exhaust Port....................................................................................................... 1-5
Air Intake Port .................................................................................................... 1-5
Remote Display Connections........................................................................................ 1-6
Communication Ports (Remote Display) ............................................................ 1-7
Printer ........................................................................................................................... 1-8
Accessory Tray ............................................................................................................. 1-8
Veris 8600 Configurations............................................................................................. 1-9

Section 2 - Monitor Setup


Battery Power ............................................................................................................... 2-1
Charging the Battery .......................................................................................... 2-1
Battery Indicators ............................................................................................... 2-2
System Start and Auto-calibration ................................................................................ 2-3
Sensor and Probe Messages............................................................................. 2-4
Gas Calibration .................................................................................................. 2-4
Screen Display and Interface........................................................................................ 2-5
Waveform Slots.................................................................................................. 2-6
Numerical Parameter Boxes .............................................................................. 2-9
Main Menu ....................................................................................................... 2-11
Alarm and Message Areas............................................................................... 2-12
System Status Box........................................................................................... 2-12
Patient Information and Clock .......................................................................... 2-12
Keypad........................................................................................................................ 2-13

Page iii

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Softkey Functions (Main Menu)................................................................................... 2-14


Changing Settings ............................................................................................ 2-14
Saved Setting Profiles ...................................................................................... 2-15
ALARMS Softkey......................................................................................................... 2-16
Primary ALARMS Window................................................................................ 2-17
Invasive Blood Pressure Alarm Settings ..........................................................2-18
Agent Gas Alarms ............................................................................................ 2-19
PARAMS Softkey (Physiological Parameters) ............................................................ 2-21
Primary PARAMS Window ...............................................................................2-21
SpO2, Respiration, Temperature Menu ............................................................ 2-25
Gas Settings ..................................................................................................... 2-26
DISPLAY Softkey ........................................................................................................ 2-28
Waveform Description ...................................................................................... 2-28
Double Height Slots.......................................................................................... 2-29
Cascaded Slots ................................................................................................2-30
Gain and Sweep ............................................................................................... 2-31
ADM/DIS Softkey (Admit/Discharge)...........................................................................2-32
Admitting and Discharging Patients.................................................................. 2-32
Adult/Pediatric/Neonatal (Patient Size) ............................................................ 2-33
Patient Information ........................................................................................... 2-33
Procedure for Admitting a Patient..................................................................... 2-34
Procedure for Discharging a Patient................................................................. 2-34
CONFIG Softkey (System Configuration).................................................................... 2-35
Password Protection......................................................................................... 2-36
Date Format...................................................................................................... 2-36
Time/Date Setting............................................................................................. 2-36
Freeze Timeout ................................................................................................2-36
Standby Timeout .............................................................................................. 2-36
Standby Tone ................................................................................................... 2-36
Alarm Tone Warning......................................................................................... 2-36
Print Device ...................................................................................................... 2-36
Language Settings............................................................................................ 2-37
PRINT Softkey............................................................................................................. 2-38
Default Settings ........................................................................................................... 2-39
Factory Defaults ............................................................................................... 2-39

Section 3 - Alarms and Messages


Alarm Description .......................................................................................................... 3-1
Remote Display Alarms ...................................................................................... 3-1
Audible Alarms ................................................................................................... 3-1
Visible Alarms..................................................................................................... 3-2
Waveforms Frozen ............................................................................................. 3-2
Alert Icons........................................................................................................... 3-3
Special Alarm Conditions .............................................................................................. 3-3
Alarms at Start Up .............................................................................................. 3-3
Alarm Silence ..................................................................................................... 3-3
Alarms tone warning (Warning Tone)................................................................. 3-4
Alarm Volume ..................................................................................................... 3-4
Minimum Volume Auto-Reset............................................................................. 3-4
Standby Mode .................................................................................................... 3-5
Agent Standby Mode .......................................................................................... 3-5
Standby Mode Timeout ...................................................................................... 3-5
SpO2 Low Limit Auto-Reset................................................................................ 3-5
SpO2 Low Limit Off Alarm .................................................................................. 3-5
Triggering an Alarm....................................................................................................... 3-6
Alarms Testing .............................................................................................................. 3-6

Page iv

Contents

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Alarm Message List ...................................................................................................... 3-7


Shared Source Alarms ....................................................................................... 3-7
ECG Alarms ....................................................................................................... 3-7
SpO2 Alarms ...................................................................................................... 3-7
Temperature Alarms .......................................................................................... 3-8
NIBP Alarms....................................................................................................... 3-9
IBP Alarms ....................................................................................................... 3-10
Capnometry (CO2) Alarms and Messages....................................................... 3-11
Agent Gas Alarms and Messages.................................................................... 3-11
Oxygen Monitoring (O2) Alarms ....................................................................... 3-13
System Alerts.............................................................................................................. 3-14

Section 4 - Trends
Description .................................................................................................................... 4-1
Trend Interval ..................................................................................................... 4-1
Capacity ............................................................................................................. 4-1
Trend Screen Update......................................................................................... 4-1
Trend Setup .................................................................................................................. 4-2
Graphical Trends .......................................................................................................... 4-4
Scrolling the Graph ............................................................................................ 4-4
Interruption Due to Power Cycling or Standby Mode ......................................... 4-4
Graphical Trend Display..................................................................................... 4-5
Tabular Trends.............................................................................................................. 4-6
Tabular Trend Markers....................................................................................... 4-6
Trend Messages ................................................................................................ 4-6
Data Format ....................................................................................................... 4-7
Clearing the Memory................................................................................................... 4-10

Section 5 - ECG
Theory of Operation ...................................................................................................... 5-1
Heart Rate.......................................................................................................... 5-1
ECG Measurement ............................................................................................ 5-1
ECG Module....................................................................................................... 5-2
Gating Signals.................................................................................................... 5-2
ECG Waveform Size .......................................................................................... 5-2
ECG Monitoring (Electrocardiogram)............................................................................ 5-3
Protection ........................................................................................................... 5-5
ECG Performance.............................................................................................. 5-5
Sudden Changes In Heart Rate ......................................................................... 5-5
Electrode Selection ............................................................................................ 5-6
ECG Module Interface .................................................................................................. 5-7
ECG Module Ports And Switches ...................................................................... 5-7
Battery Condition................................................................................................ 5-8
Charging the Battery .......................................................................................... 5-9
ECG Monitoring .......................................................................................................... 5-11
Patient Preparation .......................................................................................... 5-11
Lead Placement ............................................................................................... 5-12
Connecting Patient to the Monitor.................................................................... 5-14
Completion of ECG Monitoring ........................................................................ 5-15
ECG Auto Lead Switching .......................................................................................... 5-16
Primary Lead.................................................................................................... 5-16
Alternate Lead Priority...................................................................................... 5-17
Gating Interface .......................................................................................................... 5-18

Page v

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Section 6 - NIBP
Theory of Operation ...................................................................................................... 6-1
Heart Rate .......................................................................................................... 6-1
Comfort Cuff Technology ................................................................................ 6-1
Description of NIBP Measurement ..................................................................... 6-1
NIBP Clinical Testing and Accuracy ................................................................... 6-1
Cuff Inflation and Pressure Protection................................................................ 6-2
NIBP Monitoring ............................................................................................................ 6-3
Selecting Cuffs and Hoses ............................................................................................ 6-5
Placing the NIBP Cuff.................................................................................................... 6-6
Procedure...................................................................................................................... 6-7
Taking NIBP Measurements ......................................................................................... 6-8

Section 7 - SpO2
Theory of Operation ...................................................................................................... 7-1
Heart Rate .......................................................................................................... 7-1
Definition............................................................................................................. 7-1
DOX Digital Oximetry...................................................................................... 7-1
Method................................................................................................................ 7-1
SpO2 Clinical Testing and Accuracy................................................................... 7-2
Gating Signals .................................................................................................... 7-2
SpO2 Monitoring Procedures (Pulse Oximetry)............................................................. 7-3
Attaching the Probe to the Monitor................................................................................ 7-4
Attaching the Probe to the Patient................................................................................. 7-4
Finger Probe Application for Adults .................................................................... 7-6
Neonate Probe Placement ................................................................................. 7-7
SpO2 Peripheral Gating .............................................................................................. 7-10

Section 8 - IBP
Theory of Operation ...................................................................................................... 8-1
Heart Rate .......................................................................................................... 8-1
Method of Measurement..................................................................................... 8-1
IBP Clinical Testing and Accuracy...................................................................... 8-1
IBP Monitoring............................................................................................................... 8-2
Invasive Blood Pressure Transducers and Interface Cables ........................................ 8-3
IBP Interface Cable ............................................................................................ 8-3
IBP Monitoring Procedure ............................................................................................. 8-5
IBP Safety........................................................................................................... 8-6
Setup and User Calibration ................................................................................ 8-6
Zero Calibration (Quick) ..................................................................................... 8-8
Clinical Use and Arterial Waveforms .................................................................. 8-9

Section 9 - Temperature
Theory of Operation ...................................................................................................... 9-1
Temperature Monitoring Procedures............................................................................. 9-2
Directions for Use with Skin Surface Probe .................................................................. 9-4
Preparing the Equipment.................................................................................... 9-4
Attaching the Temperature Probe to the Patient ................................................ 9-4
Cleaning Probes............................................................................................................ 9-4

Page vi

Contents

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Section 10 - Anesthetic Agents


Theory of Operations .................................................................................................. 10-1
Integrated CO2 and Agent Gas Detector ......................................................... 10-1
Agent Gas Measurement ................................................................................. 10-1
Gas Monitoring Procedures ........................................................................................ 10-2
Sampling Circuit Connections .......................................................................... 10-2
Gas Monitoring Safety...................................................................................... 10-3
Water Trap ....................................................................................................... 10-4
Sampling Devices ............................................................................................ 10-5
Intubated Patients ............................................................................................ 10-5
Calibration and Startup .................................................................................... 10-6
Procedure for Gas Monitoring .......................................................................... 10-7
Occlusions........................................................................................................ 10-7
Anesthetic Gas Exhaust Recovery................................................................... 10-7

Section 11 - CO2, O2, and N2O


Theory of Operation .................................................................................................... 11-1
Respiration ....................................................................................................... 11-1
Capnometry (Measurement of CO2) ................................................................ 11-1
Measuring Oxygen (O2) ................................................................................... 11-2
CO2 Monitoring Procedure.......................................................................................... 11-4
O2 Monitoring Procedures .......................................................................................... 11-5
Interfering Gasses for O2 ................................................................................. 11-5
N2O Monitoring ........................................................................................................... 11-5

Section 12 - Printing and Data Ports


Description .................................................................................................................. 12-1
Snapshot Size .................................................................................................. 12-1
History Size ...................................................................................................... 12-1
Safety.......................................................................................................................... 12-1
Print Modes................................................................................................................. 12-2
Demand Print ................................................................................................... 12-2
Continuous Print............................................................................................... 12-2
Alarm Print ....................................................................................................... 12-2
BP Print ............................................................................................................ 12-2
Interval Print ..................................................................................................... 12-2
Freeze Print...................................................................................................... 12-3
Trend Print ....................................................................................................... 12-3
Print Formats .............................................................................................................. 12-4
Tabular Printing................................................................................................ 12-4
Graphical Printing............................................................................................. 12-4
Changing Printer Paper .............................................................................................. 12-7
Data Output Ports ....................................................................................................... 12-9
COM1 Port ....................................................................................................... 12-9
COM2 Port ..................................................................................................... 12-11
Video Port ................................................................................................................. 12-11
CSV Data Format...................................................................................................... 12-12

Appendix A: Maintenance

Page vii

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Cleaning and Disinfecting............................................................................................. A-1


Pulse Oximeter Sensors.................................................................................... A-2
Blood Pressure Cuffs......................................................................................... A-2
Temperature ...................................................................................................... A-3
Accidental Wetting........................................................................................................ A-4
Annual Safety Tests ..................................................................................................... A-5
System Testing.................................................................................................. A-5
Service Checks.................................................................................................. A-5
Maintenance Schedule................................................................................................. A-6
Long-Term Storage ...................................................................................................... A-7
Disposal........................................................................................................................ A-7

Appendix B: Unit and Configuration Defaults


Restoring the Unit Default Profile ................................................................................. B-1
Default Settings ............................................................................................................ B-1
Unit Default Settings.......................................................................................... B-1
Configuration Default Settings........................................................................... B-3
Configuration Settings for Unit Defaults ....................................................................... B-5
PARAMS Menu Settings ................................................................................... B-5
PRINT Menu Settings........................................................................................ B-6
DISPLAY Menu Settings ................................................................................... B-6
ALARMS Menu Settings.................................................................................... B-7
Other Alarm Settings ....................................................................................... B-11

Appendix C: Specifications
ECG.............................................................................................................................. C-1
ECG System...................................................................................................... C-1
ECG Module ...................................................................................................... C-1
Leadset.............................................................................................................. C-1
ECG Module Charger ........................................................................................ C-2
Heart Rate .................................................................................................................... C-2
NIBP ............................................................................................................................. C-2
SpO2 ............................................................................................................................ C-2
Invasive Blood Pressure............................................................................................... C-3
Transducer ........................................................................................................ C-3
Gating........................................................................................................................... C-3
Temperature................................................................................................................. C-3
Halogenated Agents..................................................................................................... C-4
Capnometry (CO2) ....................................................................................................... C-5
CO2 Respiration ........................................................................................................... C-5
Oxygen Monitoring (O2) ............................................................................................... C-5
Nitrous Oxide (N2O) ..................................................................................................... C-6
Pneumatics................................................................................................................... C-6
Alarms .......................................................................................................................... C-6
Trend Reports .............................................................................................................. C-6
Printer (Remote Display only) ...................................................................................... C-6
Controls ........................................................................................................................ C-7
System Outputs (Remote Display Only)....................................................................... C-7
Environmental .............................................................................................................. C-7
Mechanical/Electrical.................................................................................................... C-8
Power Supply .................................................................................................... C-8
Remote Display ................................................................................................. C-8
Main Monitor...................................................................................................... C-9

Page viii

Contents

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Appendix D: Accessories
ECG Accessories..........................................................................................................D-1
ECG Module.......................................................................................................D-1
ECG Electrode Accessories...............................................................................D-1
ECG Gating Accessories ...................................................................................D-1
SpO2 Accessories.........................................................................................................D-1
SpO2 Probes ......................................................................................................D-1
SpO2 Peripheral Gating Accessories .................................................................D-1
NIBP Accessories .........................................................................................................D-2
Reusable Cuffs...................................................................................................D-2
Disposable Cuffs ................................................................................................D-2
IBP Accessories............................................................................................................D-2
Temperature Accessories .............................................................................................D-2
Agent Accessories ........................................................................................................D-2
Miscellaneous Accessories...........................................................................................D-3
Publications...................................................................................................................D-3
Operation Manuals.............................................................................................D-3
Help Cards .........................................................................................................D-3
Installation and Service ......................................................................................D-3

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Appendix E: Troubleshooting
General Troubleshooting .............................................................................................. E-1
Troubleshooting Table .................................................................................................. E-1

Appendix F: IBP Transducer Specifications


IBP Specifications .............................................................................................. F-1
Transducer Specifications.................................................................................. F-1
Transducer Cables............................................................................................. F-1
Compliance ........................................................................................................ F-1
Defibrillation Protection ...................................................................................... F-1
High Frequency Interference.............................................................................. F-2

Appendix G: Fiber Optic Communication


Fiber Optic Network Communication Interface ............................................................ G-1
Operation ..................................................................................................................... G-1

Appendix H: Battery and Fuse Specifications


Battery Specifications ...................................................................................................H-1
Main Monitor Batteries .......................................................................................H-1
Fuse Specifications.......................................................................................................H-2
Remote Display Fuses .......................................................................................H-2
Main Monitor Fuses............................................................................................H-2
Power Supply Fuses ..........................................................................................H-2
Fuse Removal/Replacement.........................................................................................H-3
Remote Display..................................................................................................H-3
Power Supply .....................................................................................................H-4

Page ix

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This page intentionally left blank.

Page x

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

In Case of Emergency
Contact
MEDRAD, Inc. Corporate Office
One Medrad Drive
Indianola, PA 15051-0780 USA
Telephone: 1 (412) 767-2400
FAX: 1 (412) 767-4128
OTHER: 1 (800) 633-7231

CE Contact

EC REP
MEDRAD Subsidiaries

International Offices

MEDRAD, Inc. Service Repair


One Medrad Drive
Indianola, PA 15051-0780 USA
Telephone: 1 (412) 767-2400
FAX: 1 (412) 767-4126
OTHER: 1 (800) 633-7237

Medrad Europe B.V.


Postbus 205
6190 AE Beek
The Netherlands
Imaxeon Pty. Ltd.
Rydalmere Metro Centre
Unit 2, 38-46 South Street
Rydalmere NSW 2116
Australia
Telephone: +61 2 8845 4999
FAX: +61 2 8845 4998

(Alternate address:)
P.O. Box 150
Rydalmere BC
NSW 1701
Sydney, Australia

MEDRAD Europe B.V.


P.O. Box 205
6190 AE Beek
The Netherlands
Telephone: +31 (0) 43-3585601
FAX: +31 (0) 43-3656598
(Visiting MEBV address:)
Horsterweg 24
6199 AC Maastricht Airport
The Netherlands

Nihon MEDRAD K.K.


9F Central Shin-Osaka Bldg.
4-5-36, Miyahara
Yodogawa-ku
Osaka 532-0003, Japan
Telephone: +81 (0) 6-6350-0680
FAX: +81 (0) 6-6398-0670

MEDRAD do Brasil Ltda.


Av. Fagundes Filho, 191 conjuntos 51 a 54, 57 e 58
Ed. Houston Office Center
Vila Monte Alegre
04304-010 - So Paulo - SP Brazil
Telephone: + 55 (11) 5079-6500
FAX: + 55 (11) 5584-8951

Mediwest Denmark ApS


Naverland 2
2600 Glostrup
Denmark
Telephone: +45 38-16 16 16
FAX: +45 38-16 16 46

MEDRAD Middle East & Africa


92 Al Lasilky Street
New Maadi Cairo
Egypt
E-mail: Medrad_ME&A@medrad.com
(If contacting Andre directly, please
phone or fax)
+00.20.2.754.88.29

xi

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MEDRAD Veris 8600

MEDRAD France S.a.r.l.


8, rue des Pyrnes Silic 514
Wissous
F-94623 Rungis
France
Telephone: +33 (0) 1.46.86.98.84
FAX: +33 (0) 1.46.86.98.83

MEDRAD, Inc. (Asia)


200 Jalan Sultan #09-01
Textile Centre
Singapore 199018
Telephone: +(65) 6 292 5357
FAX: +(65) 6 292 7276

MEDRAD Italia S.r.l.

MEDRAD Medizinische Systeme


GmbH
Industriestrae 2b
97332 Volkach
Germany
Telephone: +49 (0) 9381/80 36 80
FAX: +49 (0) 9381/80 36 85

Via Togliatti, 111


27051 Cava Manara (PV)
Italy
Telephone: +39 (0) 382 552882
FAX: +39 (0) 382 552876
MEDRAD Mexicana S. de
R.L. de C.V.
Leibnitz, 204
Col. Anzures Del. Miguel Hidalgo
CP. 11590 Mexico City
Mexico D.F. 16018
Telephone: +52 (555) 250-6575
FAX: +52 (555) 250-9762
Mediwest Scandinavia AB
Lona Knapes gata 5, plan 2
S-421 32 Vstra Frlunda
Sweden
Telephone: +46 (0) 31-74 82 88 0
FAX: +46 (0) 31-74 82 99 9

Mediwest Norway AS
Aslakveien 14A
NO-075
3
Oslo, Norway
Telephone: +47 (0) 22-06 57 10
FAX: +47 (0) 22-06 57 15
MEDRAD UK Ltd.
25 Lancaster Way Business Park
Witchford, Ely
Cambridgeshire
CB6 3NW
Telephone: +44 (0) 1353-645024
FAX: +44 (0) 1353-645037

xii

Symbols
Symbol

Definition
European Community Mark

Regulatory Symbols

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

ETL Mark
FCC (US Federal Communications Commission)
Mark
Safety Symbols

ATTENTION! Refer to Operation Manual for


Information
Shock Hazard

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Type CF Equipment, defib proof

IPX0

Indicates no protection against ingress of water


(remote display)

IPX1

Identifies the degree of protection against fluid as


drip-proof (main monitor)

IPX2

Identifies the degree of protection against fluid as


drip-proof (power supply)
Equipotential Terminal
Protective Earth
Indicates the MR magnet and power
Indicates distance between MR magnet and monitor
Indicates the presence of a battery
Recycle batteries following hospital protocols and
local environmental regulations.
Do not incinerate! Keep away from fire or other
sources of extreme heat.

xiii

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Symbol

Definition
Dispose of batteries properly in accordance with
hospital and local regulations.
Risk of electrical shock! Do not remove cover.
Refer servicing to qualified personnel.
Fuse

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

System Symbols

Alternating Current (AC)


Direct Current (DC)
Wireless Device

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Port Symbols

Signal Input
Signal Output

IOIOI

Digital Output
Air Intake
Scavenging Port
Communication Port
Video Out

xiv

Symbols

Miscellaneous Symbols

Symbol

Definition
Technical Support Phone Number
Manufacturing Contact

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

SN
REF

Part Reference Number


Place this side against the skin (Blood Pressure Cuff)
Placement of the cuff over the brachial artery.

2
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Serial Number

Single use device only. Do not reuse.

xv

Safety

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Definitions

Definitions for Warning, Caution, and Note symbols:


!

WARNING !

Designates a possible dangerous situation.


Non-observance may lead to death or the most
severe injuries.

CAUTION !

Designates a possible dangerous situation.


Non-observance may lead to minor injuries or
damage to the product.

NOTE: Indicates that important information follows, a tip that can help
you recover from an error, or point you to related details in the
manual.
Warnings

WARNING !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Read this manual entirely before using the monitor.


Inspect For Damage! User should inspect the system for signs
of damage. Do not use the system if failure is evident or
suspected.
Possible burn hazard! Do not coil cables inside the MR scanner.
Possible explosion hazard! Do not use the monitor in the
presence of flammable anesthetics. The equipment is not
suitable for use in the presence of a flammable anesthetic
mixture with air or with oxygen or Nitrous Oxide.
Possible explosion hazard! Do not use the monitor in the
presence of gas mixtures which may be flammable.
Do not use this device in conjunction with flammable
anesthetics such as cyclopropane and ether. The monitor can
sample from pure oxygen environments, but the monitor itself
should never be placed inside an oxygen rich environment, such
as an oxygen tent or gas containment apparatus. Proper
anesthetic gas waste recovery should be used. When not in
operation, this device is not intended to be connected to any
pressurized source containing an enriched oxygen environment.
Cables, tubing, and lead wires may present a risk of
entanglement or strangulation! Verify safe and proper
positioning of these items at all times.
Unapproved modifications to the monitor may cause unexpected
results and present a hazard to the patient.
Risk of electrical shock! Do not remove cover. Refer servicing to
qualified personnel.

xvi

Safety

WARNING !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

All cords must have hospital grade plugs and be plugged into
hospital grade outlets. (The electrical installation of the relevant
room must comply with NFPA 70: National Electric Code or
NFPA 99: Standard for Health Care Facilities. Outside the
United States, the relevant room must comply with all electrical
installation regulations mandated by the local and regional
bodies of government).
Do not bring tools containing ferrous material into the magnet
room. Risk of serious injury and/or damage to equipment can
occur.
Do not route gating cables near or within the scanning volume.
Apply brakes to prevent movement.
Do not re-use accessories labeled as single use. Risk of patient
contamination may occur.
Improper disposal of batteries may result in explosion, leakage,
or personal injury. Do not open batteries. Do not dispose of
batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations concerning the
disposal of spent Lead-acid and Lithium-Ion batteries or contact
MEDRAD for assistance.
Connect only MEDRAD approved three-lead or five-lead ECG
cables from the patient to the ECG module. Do not connect any
other signal source to the ECG module.
There is no defibrillator synchronization output on the Veris
monitor. Make no connections between the Veris and a
defibrillator.
Leakage currents may increase if other equipment is
interconnected to the patient. The increased leakage currents
may present a hazard to the patient.
PACEMAKER PATIENTS: This device does not include
pacemaker spike rejection capability. Heart rate readouts
derived from the ECG patient connections are likely to display
erroneous high or erratic rates when a pacemaker is in use.
Keep pacemaker patients under close surveillance. For
pacemaker patients it may be advisable to select the SpO2
function as the primary heart rate source.
High Frequency (HF) surgical equipment may affect ECG
operation. The system is not designed to operate in the
presence of ESU interference. The patient may be burned.
Patient burns can also result from a defective HF surgical
equipment neutral electrode connection.
The heart rate calculated by the monitor may be affected by
cardiac arrhythmia.

xvii

MEDRAD Veris 8600

WARNING !

Do not stand on the power supply enclosure. Injury from tripping


or falling can occur.
Do not stand on the base. Possible injury can result from falling.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not take the remote display or the ECG module battery


charger into the MR scanner room. These contain ferromagnetic
material and can be strongly attracted to the magnet causing a
safety hazard.
Do not use with an open MRI. Use of the monitor in an open
MRI may result in erratic or unavailable monitoring.
Do not stand or sit on monitor accessories tray. Possible injury
can result from falling.
Do not lift the monitoring system by the tray. Possible injury can
result from heavy weight.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

U.S. Federal law restricts this device to sale by or on the order


of a physician.
Cautions

CAUTION !

Use only accessories designated for use with this monitor. Use
of accessories not designated for use with the Veris monitor can
cause inaccurate measurements and/or a safety hazard for the
patient.
This device has been tested to IEC 60601-1-2 specified levels
for emissions of and immunity to electrical interference. External
disturbances which exceed these levels, such as motor driven
tools, may cause operational issues with this device. Other
devices which are sensitive to a lower level of emissions than
those allowed by IEC 60601-1-2 may experience operational
issues when used in proximity to this device.
Equipment accuracy may be affected at extreme temperatures.
Do not store equipment at extreme temperature. Temperatures
exceeding specified storage temperatures could damage the
system.
Avoid routing the DC cable or any other cable through the
magnet room door. Possible damage can occur to the cable(s)
and/or the scanner room door.
Do not press on the keys with sharp or hard objects. This could
damage the keys. Use only your fingertips to press on the keys.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by MEDRAD,
Inc., may void the user's authority to operate the equipment and
may also void the warranty.

xviii

Safety

CAUTION !

Do not use the monitor in the path of a Linear Accelerator or


Positron Emission Tomography (PET) scanner beam. This could
result in inaccurate physiologic parameters or waveforms.
Transporting the monitor in a mobile scanner trailer can lead to
damage from shock, vibration, or extreme temperatures.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not allow the conductive parts of the patient electrodes to


contact other conductive parts, including ground (earth).
Do not tip the monitor. Possible injury can result from falling.
Do not pinch cables between the table and the bore. This can
damage the cables.
Do not roll the monitor over or step on cables. This can damage
the cables.
Do not bend fiber optic cables too tightly. See Specifications in
Appendix C for proper bending of fiber optic cables.
If a probe falls on the floor or into liquid, clean the probe
following proper cleaning methods. If the probe is not properly
cleaned, inaccurate physiologic parameters or waveforms may
result.
Do not place more than 40 pounds (18 kg) on the tray.
Leakage Current

The monitor complies with leakage current limits required by medical


safety standards for patient-connected devices. The Veris monitor
conforms to EN 60601-1 standards. A hazard caused by the
summation of leakage currents is possible, when several pieces of
equipment are interconnected.

Voltage Fluctuations

When operated in the line voltage range specified in this manual any
minor fluctuations will have a negligible effect. Very low line voltage
will cause the monitor to revert to battery power. Very high line
voltage may cause damage to the charger circuits. The monitor is
designed with circuitry that will turn the unit off before spurious
readings can be caused by a low battery condition.

xix

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Equipotential Ground

Health care providers and patients are subject to dangerous,


uncontrollable compensating currents for electrical equipment.
These currents are due to the potential differences between
connected equipment and touchable conducting parts as found in
medical rooms.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The safety solution to the problem is accomplished with consistent


equipotential bonding. The remote display and the main monitor
power supply are fitted with connecting leads made up with angled
sockets to the equipotential bonding network in medical rooms.
Equipotential
Terminal

Connection Lead
(Socket)
Equipotential
Connector

Main
Body

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Earth Ground
Software Version

The initial release of this monitoring system was at a software


revision of 1.0 on the main monitor and 1.0 on the remote display on
4 January 2005. This revision could be advanced for many reasons
following the initial release. To identify the presently installed revision
on either the main monitor or remote display, power-up the monitor
while observing the initial power-on screen. The current software
revision will be displayed prior to display of the normal monitoring
screen.

Software Error Related


Hazard Mediation

MEDRAD, Inc., has quality control practices and procedures in place


to review potential hazards as they relate to software. The monitor
utilizes a four-digit year for all date, time, and leap year calculations.

Potential Interference

MAGNETIC FIELDS

Always position the Veris Base, Base Plus, and Cardiac monitors at
or outside the 2000 Gauss line. Always position the Veris Anesthesia
monitor at or outside of the 500 Gauss line. This monitor is designed
specifically for MR compatibility and is 1.5 and 3T compatible. It will
not cause interference with MRI image quality, nor will its
performance be affected by the magnet field.
The "T" wave may become excessively large or inverted with the
patient in the magnetic field. This effect is due to hemodynamic flow
induced voltage and may interfere with QRS detection. Try other
leads and/or electrode placements for best results.
CONDUCTED TRANSIENTS

The monitor conforms with IEC 61000-4-4, and IEC 61000-4-5 for
conducted transients, and will operate with negligible adverse effects.

xx

Safety

X-RAY, CT, ULTRASOUND, AND/OR NUCLEAR MEDICINE

The monitor will operate with negligible adverse effects in these


environments. However, the monitor should not be placed directly in
the radiated beam, which could damage the internal electronics of the
monitor.
OTHER INTERFERENCE

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

There is a negligible adverse effect to the monitor from infrared


energy and defibrillation.
CABLING INTERFERENCE

Route all Veris system cabling away from other manufacturer cables
in the magnet room.
Biocompatibility

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Probes Fall in Fluids

FCC and Industry Canada


Compliance

All patient-contact or user-contact materials in this monitor and it's


accessories have passed ISO 10993-5, -10, & -11 biocompatibility
tests or have been in use in clinical environments in large numbers
over an extended period of time predating these standards.
Whenever probes fall and land in fluids, clean the probes according to
the cleaning instructions in Cleaning and Disinfecting on page A-1.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including
intereference that may cause undesired operation.
!

WARNING !

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party


responsible for compliance could void the users authority to
operate the equipment.
The term IC before the certification/registration number only
signifies that the Industry Canada technical specifications were met.
IC: 5338A-CSI8600
Audible Pulse Tone

Disposal Accessory Disposal

Latex Content

The amplitude of the audible pulse tone remains constant regardless


of changes in patient parameter measurements.
Discard disposable medical waste according to your institution's
policies and procedures to prevent biological contamination. See
Disposal on page A-7.
This MEDRAD product (patient monitors and approved accessories)
is free from latex in any location that may result in patient contact.

xxi

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Introduction
Description

The VerisTM 8600 patient monitor is designed for use in the MRI
environment. It interprets and displays physiologic data as waveforms
and numeric information which, depending on the configuration of the
system, may include ECG, NIBP, SpO2, CO2, respiration,
temperature, O2, anesthetic gases, and IBP. User defined alarm limits
and alerts may be set for each parameter. Monitored parameter data
is stored as tabular trend information and may be printed or
downloaded.

Intended Use

The system is intended to monitor physiological parameters of


patients within any health care environment, specifically in the MR
environment. The user, responsible to interpret the monitored data
made available, will be a professional health care provider.
Physiological data, gas monitoring, system alarms, and patient
analysis will be available to the care provider from the monitor.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The monitor is MR compatible based on the FDA guidelines for


equipment to be used in MR.
There are two distinct needs for patient monitors in MR:
Vital signs monitoring, to monitor medically unstable patients or
patients under conscious sedation, as required by the JCAHO.
And, provide image gating, to gate image acquisition to a
physiological parameter, such as the cardiac cycle.
There is the additional requirement for the accurate function of the
equipment in the MR environment. The monitor used in the scan
room shall not be affected by the radio frequency pulse or gradient
fields and shall not produce any RF interference on the image.
The monitor (including accessories) is capable of monitoring a full
range of patients from neonate to adult.

xxii

Introduction

Clinical Use

This manual provides separate sections for measured parameters.


These sections provide instructions for patient connections and
monitoring. The caregiver is expected to be fully familiar with patient
monitoring techniques and with the functions of this monitor before
using it with a patient.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

This system is designed to only monitor one patient at a time per


monitoring system.
Before you Begin

Protect yourself and your patient. Read the precautions for each
measured parameter that appears in each measured parameter
section.
These instructions describe the use of the basic sampling devices
and accessories that come with your monitor. An extended list of
approved accessories can be found in Accessories in Appendix D of
this manual.
The monitor should always be checked by the caregiver before use
for actual patient monitoring. Perform the following procedure before
using the monitor with each patient.
1. Make sure the monitor has been fully charged before use.
Check that the AC (Mains) power cord is plugged in for longterm monitoring situations.
2. Check the menus and default settings to confirm that the
monitor is setup correctly.
3. Examine the accessories for wear, damage, or contamination.
Replace or disinfect the accessories as required.
4. Turn the desired monitoring modules to ON in the PARAMS
softkey window.
5. Select the correct mode of operation (Adult/Pediatric/Neonate)
by entering the patient size in the ADM/DIS softkey window.

CAUTION !

All accessories connected to the patient monitor must comply


with all applicable UL (Underwriters Laboratories) standards
and IEC standards for such products.
Substitution of recommended sensor and sampling accessories
may cause inaccurate measurements and degrade patient
safety, or may damage the monitor.

xxiii

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1 Panel Features
This section provides an overview of the Veris 8600 monitors control
panels, switches, accessory connections, and communication
sockets.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Front Panel

The front panels of the monitor and the optional remote display
feature a color flat-screen display. Located below the screen is the
primary control panel equipped with the power button, eight
dedicated function keys and a menu knob. Menu selections are
displayed on the screen and can be selected via the menu knob. The
keypad is push-button style, composed of a touch-sensitive
membrane.
The water trap receptacle is also located on the front of the main
monitor (Anesthesia units only).
Color Display

Water Trap
Receptacle
(Anesthesia
Monitors only)

Power
Switch

Keypad

Menu
Knob

Figure 1-1: Veris 8600 Front Controls

1 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

A green LED indicator is located above the power (ON/OFF) key. The
indicator is on if AC power is present.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Sampling
Line
AC Power
Connection Indicator

Water Trap

Function
Keys

Menu Knob

Figure 1-2: Detail of Lower Front Panel

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Menu Knob

Color Display

Water Trap and


Gas Sampling Connection

The menu knob can be turned left or right to make selections from
any of the menus that appear on the front display. The selected menu
option can then be activated by pressing in on the menu knob.
The display provides real-time waveform and numerical data of the
measured parameters. Additional menus and menu options which
may be selected and activated by the menu knob are also displayed
on this and the optional remote display screen.
The water trap connection is a feature on Anesthesia and Anesthesia
with Temperature models only. MEDRAD Veris monitors without gas
analysis capability have a blank plate in this location. The water trap
is easily accessed on the front of the monitor. The gas sampling line
is connected to the water trap and it is used for CO2, O2, N2O, and
agent monitoring. The sample line fitting is a standard female Luerlock connector when using the WaterChek2+ water trap accessory.

1 2

1 Panel Features

Left Side Panel (Main Monitor)

The left side of the main monitor has up to nine connections for
patient monitoring. The electrocardiogram (ECG), pulse oximetry
(SpO2), and the non-invasive blood pressure (NIBP) connections are
standard on all Veris 8600 models.
All potential Veris main monitor connections are described in the
picture below.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The optional remote display has no patient connections.


More information about accessory connections can be found in the
patient monitoring sections of this manual.
ECG Input/
Output
Temperature
Gating
Signal

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

SpO2
IBP

NIBP

Figure 1-3: Veris 8600 Left Side

1 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Communication Port
(Main Monitor)

There are two fiber optic ports at the bottom of the monitor. One is an
input port and the other an output port. These ports, on both the main
monitor and the remote display, are for fiber optic communication
between the main monitor and the remote display. See the
Installation Instructions for installing the fiber optic communications.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

See Figure 1-8: Remote Display Fiber Optic Connections on


page 1-7 for the location of the fiber optic ports on the remote display.
NOTES: These connections have protective covers that need to be
removed before use.
Do not use any other communication connectors on the main monitor.
These are for service use only.

Fiber Optic
Input and
Output
Connectors

Figure 1-4: Main Monitor Fiber Optic Connections

1 4

1 Panel Features

Main Monitor Base


Connections
DC Connection

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Exhaust Port

Air Intake
Port

DC Connection & Exhaust Port


Figure 1-5: Main Monitor Base Connections
Chassis Ground
DC Connection

The Veris monitor has an internal chassis ground.


A DC power cable connection is located at the center of the base of
the patient monitor. Attach the cable from the power supply in this
socket.
!

CAUTION !

Ensure that the cable from the power source to the monitor base
is placed in an area free from traffic to prevent tripping and/or
damage to the cable.
Exhaust Port

The exhaust port is located on the base of the Anesthesia monitor


assembly by the DC connection. The scavenging kit fits this nozzle.
Use the scavenging kit and a waste gas recovery system when
anesthetic agents are present in gas samples.

Air Intake Port

An ambient air intake port (located next to the exhaust port on the
base of the Anesthesia monitor assembly) is used for making zero
gas concentration calibrations. Do not block or attach anything to the
air intake port.

1 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Remote Display Connections

The remote display displays the patient data in another location.


Changes to the display can be made from the remote display and be
effected on the patient monitor.
Printer Feed
Advance

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Printer Release
Lever

Printer
Door

Service
Access
Panel
Fuse
Access
Panel

Communication
Connections

Chassis
Ground

AC Power
Connection

Figure 1-6: Remote Display Rear View

1 6

1 Panel Features

Communication Ports
(Remote Display)

There are three communications sockets available along the back


edge of the remote display. These connections provide links to
external printers, computers, and other medical devices. See
Printing and Data Ports in Section 12 for more information about
serial printing and communications

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

COM Port 1
Serial DB-9
COM Port 2
Mini DIN 8
Not Used

Video Port

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Not Used

Figure 1-7: Communication Ports (Remote Display)


There are also two fiber optic ports on the right side of the remote
display. These ports, on both the main monitor and the remote
display, are for fiber optic communication between the main monitor
and the remote display. See the Installation Instructions for installing
the fiber optic communications.
NOTE: These connections have protective covers that need to be
removed before use.

Fiber Optic
Input and
Output
Connectors

Figure 1-8: Remote Display Fiber Optic Connections

1 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Printer

This printer door provides quick access to the internal printer paper
spool. The printer lever releases the printer rollers for removing
jammed paper. The knob can be turned to feed paper. See Printing
and Data Ports in Section 12 for additional printer information.
Printers are only available on Veris 8600 remote displays.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Accessory Tray

The monitor has an integral accessories tray where the user can
store and hang accessories.

WARNING !

Do not stand or sit on monitor accessories tray. Possible injury


can result from falling.
Do not lift the monitoring system by the tray. Possible injury can
result from heavy weight.

CAUTION !

Do not place more than 40 pounds (18 kg) on the tray.

Figure 1-9: Accessory Tray

1 8

1 Panel Features

Veris 8600 Configurations

There are six factory-set configurations and one optional remote


display available. See below for configuration options.
Number

Description

Features

3011991 Base MR Monitor

Standard 3-lead ECG, SpO2, and NIBP

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3011992 BasePlus MR Monitor


3011993 Cardiology configuration

3011994
3011995

3011996
3010482

Base plus Remote Display


Base plus 5-lead ECG, ECG Gating,
SpO2 Gating, IBP.
The Remote Display is optional.
Cardiology with Temperature Cardiology plus Temperature.
The Remote Display is optional.
Anesthesia configuration
Base plus 5-lead ECG, ECG Gating,
SpO2 Gating, IBP, O2, CO2, N2O,
agents.
The Remote Display is optional.
Anesthesia with Temperature Anesthesia plus Temperature.
The Remote Display is optional.
Remote Display
Remote display with printer and fiber
optic communications.

The instructions in this manual cover the operation of each of the


option packages listed above. For those models that do not include a
particular monitoring module (i.e. Agents), the system functions as if
that module is turned off.

1 9

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2 Monitor Setup
This section provides an overview of the setup procedures for the
Veris 8600 monitor. Also see the appropriate chapters on patient
parameter monitoring for parameter setup information.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The monitor should be set up by the health care provider before using
it on patients:
Load paper (if remote display is present). See paper loading
instructions in Changing Printer Paper on page 12-7.
Charge all batteries (ECG module battery, main monitor
batteries.)
Preparations such as charging the batteries should be performed if
the monitor is new.
Battery Power

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Charging the Battery

The monitor base contains two lead-acid gel batteries that when fully
charged provide a minimum of ten hours of operational use.
The Veris monitor is battery powered. The monitor internally
recharges the battery when it is connected to the power supply. The
monitor can operate in continuous use for a minimum of 10 hours on
a fully charged battery. Charge the battery from the power supply
overnight for approximately 12 hours.

WARNING !

If the electrical integrity of the earth ground is in doubt, the


power cord should be disconnected and the machine should be
operated from its internal electrical power source.
Explosion hazard. Keep lighted cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery.
Avoid contact with battery acid! The batteries contains sulfuric
acid electrolyte which can cause severe burns and eye damage,
as well as illness from sulfur oxide fumes. Use necessary
precautions when servicing batteries.
Do not short circuit the battery terminals. The resulting highcurrent discharge can cause burns.
Do not operate the monitor with discharged or defective
batteries. Monitor failure could occur during AC power loss
which can compromise patient safety.
Do not use the monitor if the batteries are missing.

2 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The Veris monitor can function on AC or battery power. MEDRAD


recommends that batteries be fully charged at all times. If the
batteries are insufficiently charged, battery life is degraded and
shortened. If defective batteries are suspected, contact MEDRAD
Service or your local representative.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Battery Indicators

The battery icons are located on the lower portion of the main screen
as described in Screen Display and Interface on page 2-5. The
battery icons change color to indicate the status of the batteries and
appear when using DC (battery) or AC (Mains) power.
When AC is connected to the monitor (green light above ON/OFF key
is lit), the battery icon colors are:
Amber:

Battery is charging.

Green:

Battery is fully charged or not present.

When AC is not connected to the monitor (green light above ON/OFF


key is not lit), the battery icon colors are:
Green:

Battery life is greater than 1 hour.

Yellow:

Battery is weak. (less than 1 hour and more than 15


minutes of charge remains). A LOW BAT message
also appears.

Black:

Battery is nearly drained. (less than 15 minutes of


charge remain). The LOW BAT message remains.

While using battery power there is a short delay between a change in


battery status and the updated display of the battery icons.
If the monitor is currently operating under AC power, the monitor may
take up to two minutes to display a change in battery status.
The monitor also displays the battery status for the ECG module in
the heart rate (HR) parameter box. The battery icon colors are:
Green:

Battery life is greater than seven (7) hours.

Yellow:

Battery life is less than seven (7) hours. Charge the


module battery soon

Black:

This can indicate the ECG module is not connected


to the monitor. Verify the module is connected to the
monitor.
If the ECG module is connected, verify that the
module is turned on.
If the module is connected to the monitor and turned
on, the battery is drained. ECG module will not
operate. Charge the module battery immediately.

2 2

2 Monitor Setup

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

System Start and


Auto-calibration

To power up the main monitor, press the ON/OFF key located on the
front, left side of the control panel. If your system has a remote
display, power is applied via the same key on that component.

ON/OFF Key

Figure 2-1: ON/OFF Key


MAIN MONITOR

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Immediately upon power up, the Veris monitor displays the Veris
splash screen. The software version appears on the screen.
OPTIONAL REMOTE DISPLAY

Immediately upon power up, the optional Veris remote display


displays the Veris splash screen. The software version appears on the
screen. A paper feed also automatically activates.
Audible alarms are suspended for each parameter until the first
valid measurement has been taken for each parameter. Visual
alerts are always active.
If a patient had been previously admitted by the monitor, a
notice message RESUME MONITORING appears in a yellow
box. Press the knob to continue monitoring with the current
patient. Select NO to change the patient.
HR

1mV
II

BPM

--- %

ECG

x1
1mV
aVR

SpO2

Resume Monitoring

x2

CO2

SpO2

--

EXP

Same patient? YES

RESP

Br/m

-150 ml/min

x1

INS

CO2

GAS

O2

200
ART1
0
20
CVP2
0
T1

17 0.4 1.1
21 2.3 3.8

--.--.-

ISO

mmHg

IBP1 ART

---/---

(---)

MAP
CYCLE OFF
SPO2: SENSOR
ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1
V000 - NO ADMIT
ZERO IP2 - + - + Adult
ADM/DIS CONFIG PRINT

T2

HAL

---/---

(---)

IBP2

CVP

mmHg

-14:12:59

Figure 2-2: Resume Monitoring Dialogue Box

2 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The monitor is comprised of a number of modules which measure


physiologic parameters. Some modules such as the oximeter are
ready for use within seconds of power up. Others such as the gas
bench take a few minutes to equilibrate.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Sensor and Probe Messages

Depending on the accessories attached to the monitor upon start up,


various messages concerning detached sensors and probes appear.
These are only visual alarms until valid measurements are taken by
the accessories, after which a low level alarm sounds when the
sensors and probes are disconnected.
NOTE: ECG LEADS OFF messages can be set by the user to be
Low, Medium, or High level alarms.
If sensor and probe messages from unused modules become a
distraction, these messages may be eliminated by turning the
respective module off. The OFF settings are located in the PARAMS
windows described in PARAMS Softkey (Physiological Parameters)
on page 2-21.
Units with invasive blood pressure capability indicate that either there
is no transducer attached (NO XDUCER) or that the transducer has
not been calibrated by the user (NOT ZEROED). In either case it is
not necessary to attach or zero the transducers in order to use the
other features of the monitor.

Gas Calibration

The agent gas detector may require a short warm up period and autocalibration sequence similar to an internal capnometer. The message
AGT:WARMING appears in the information message area. The
informational message AGT:MANUAL or AGT:AUTOMATIC also
appears indicating that the monitor is in either manual or automatic
primary agent identification mode. AGT: AUTO CAL indicates that the
agent calibration is in progress.
Respiration waveforms, capnogram, and numerical breath rate are
available in one minute from applying power to the monitor. The
monitor reaches full accuracy for agent concentrations in less than 20
minutes.
If the Veris system fails to auto-calibrate upon power up, the message
AGT:BAD CAL appears. Power cycle the monitor. If the system
continues to fail auto-calibration, contact MEDRAD Service or your
local representative.
The oxygen monitoring module also requires auto-calibration, which
is performed at the same time as the agent bench calibration. If the
O2 module fails to calibrate, the message O2:SENSOR appears.
Upon successfully completing auto-calibration the monitor displays
values for monitored gases.

2 4

2 Monitor Setup

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Screen Display and Interface

The display is divided into dedicated areas for data and interface
functions. The left side of the screen is reserved for waveform (up to
six) or graphic display. The uppermost waveform slot is factory set for
ECG. The remaining five waveform slots can be configured by the
user. The alarm silence icon (2 minutes or permanent) is shown in
the upper right corner of the first waveform.
The far right column is dedicated to reporting numerical data, except
for NIBP and temperature which appear below the waveforms. The
color of each parameter is user selectable. A waveform and its
corresponding numeric data appear in the same color.
Heart Rate
Numerical
Parameters

Waveform Slot 1

Gating

ECG Module
Battery
Status

Remote
Communication

Waveform Slot 2

Gas Numerical
Parameters

Waveform Slot 3

SpO2

Waveform Slot 4
Waveform Slot 5
Waveform Slot 6

CO2 Numerical
Parameters

Temperature 1
Temperature 2

Respiration

IBP Channel 1
Parameters
NIBP Parameters

ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1


ADM/DIS CONFIG
PRINT ZERO IP2

Priority Alarms
Info Messages
System Status

Patient Data

IBP Channel 2
Parameters
Date

Time

Figure 2-3: Screen Diagram


The main menu is shown in grey above. The arrangement of the
numerical parameter boxes varies depending upon the waveforms
selected to be viewed and the waveform slot selected for the
waveform. The parameter box displays to the right of its
corresponding waveform if displayed in a waveform slot. The screen
display is the same on the patient monitor and the remote display.
Changes to the display can be made at the patient monitor or at the
remote display.
The bottom portion of the display has space dedicated to the
following message types and functions.
The main screen menu of selectable softkeys.
Two message lines for alarms and alerts.
A system status line for battery status and patient size mode.
The patient information bar, date stamp, and clock.

2 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

NOTE: Your screen may appear different from below based on


waveforms selected and their chosen slots.
HR

1mV
II

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

-+

60

ECG
HAL
GAS O2
N2O
%
EXP
INS
Mixed ENF EXP 10.5 INS 10.0
RESP Br/m
SpO2

x1
1mV
aVR

17 0.4
21 2.3

x2
SpO2

98

x1

CO2

CO2
200
ART1
0
20
CVP2
0
T1

EXP

37

INS

39
64

20
200 ml/min

mmHg

IBP1 ART

96.4
97.7

NIBP

AGE

21:13 min

149/106

mmHg

(127)

MAP
CYCLE OFF
SPO2: SENSOR
ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1
V000 - NO ADMIT
ZERO IP2 + - + - Adult
ADM/DIS CONFIG PRINT

T2

BPM

145/105

(125)

IBP2

CVP

mmHg

13
AUG-16-04

14:12:59

Figure 2-4: Sample Interface Screen


Waveform Slots

1mV
II

x1
1mV
aVR

x2
SpO2

x1
CO2
200
ART1
0
20
CVP2
0

The monitor has the capability to display up to six waveforms


simultaneously.
The first trace is factory set to only display an ECG waveform. The
user may select the lead type for this trace. All other displayed
waveforms are user selectable.
Each waveform slot displays the parameter or source along the left
edge of the screen. Amplitude bar and range are shown at the
beginning of the slot if applicable to that type of waveform. The color
of each waveform may be selected by the user. The waveform slots
can be combined to form double high waveforms and waveforms can
be cascaded to fill multiple slots. See Double Height Slots on
page 2-29 and Cascaded Slots on page 2-30 for details.
NOTE: The SpO2 waveform display is not necessarily directly
proportional to pulse volume. The SpO2 waveform display is not
automatically gain adjusted.

2 6

2 Monitor Setup

VISUAL ALARMS WITH WAVEFORMS

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The waveform slots are also used to display physiological alarms that
will appear at the top center of each slot. For a high priority alarm the
color of the message is red. For a medium priority alarm, the color of
the message is yellow.
The bottom five slots may be covered by menus and messages.
Since the top waveform slot is dedicated to ECG, the ECG waveform
and the ECG high and medium priority messages are always visible if
ECG is currently being monitored and the top slot is active.
See Visible Alarms on page 3-2 for a complete description of visual
alarms.
SILENCE ALERT STATUS

The silence alert visual icon appears in the upper right area of the top
waveform.
The silence icon shows a bell with an "X" and an infinity symbol
when the SILENCE hard key has been pressed and held for
more than two seconds.
The Alarm Suspend icon shows a bell with an X and the words
2 Min when the SILENCE hard key has been momentarily
pressed.
ALARM INHIBIT

The alarm inhibit icon appears in the parameter boxes when one or
more of an individual parameters alarms are turned OFF.
ECG WAVEFORM

The lead number and scale setting are displayed in the top left corner
of each slot set for ECG waveforms. The amplitude bar, shown in
white, indicates the scale in millivolts (mV).
SPO2 WAVEFORM

The waveform is auto ranging where the monitor attempts to keep the
waveform centered in the slot at all times. No amplitude bar is shown.
CO2 WAVEFORM

The CO2 waveform, capnogram, is always displayed in percent


regardless of the units selected for displaying the numerical data. The
maximum range of the capnometer waveform is 12.5%.
BREATH BY BREATH BAR GRAPH (BB)

The breath by breath bar graph is a method of representing the


concentration of CO2 at the end of each breath. The data is always
displayed in percent with a maximum range of 12.5%.
O2 WAVEFORM

The maximum range of the oxygen waveform is 100%. The units are
always in percent.

2 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

PRIMARY AGENT WAVEFORM

The primary agent waveform is displayed in percentage only as is the


display for primary agent numerical data. The waveform is autoranging within the slot. Secondary agents are not displayed as
waveforms.
NITROUS OXIDE (N2O)

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

IBP WAVEFORMS

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The N2O waveform is derived from the agent detector of the Veris
monitor.

Selectable IBP sites are as follows:

The labels identifying the source of the IBP waveforms appear


between the upper and lower range values at the beginning of the
waveform.
The waveform has both manual and auto-ranging features. The
selected range appears at the left side of the waveform. The scaling
for IBP slots are locked at x1 and cannot be changed. Use the range
settings to adjust the appearance of the waveform on the screen. See
Alarms and Messages in Section 3 for details.

Arterial (ART)
Pulmonary Artery (PA)
Central Venous (CVP)
Right Atrial (RA)
Left Atrial (LA)
Intracranial (ICP)
Left Ventricle (LV)
Right Ventricle (RV)

There are two IBP channels. The color of each channel can be
selected independently.
If the amplitude of the waveform exceeds the selected range the
waveform is clipped. An informational level alarm OFF SCALE
appears in the Info Messages Box of the main screen display.

2 8

2 Monitor Setup

Numerical Parameter Boxes

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

If a module is turned off in the PARAMS menu, the numerical


parameters are replaced by the word OFF in each location. Smart
parameters such as heart rate switch to another available module if
possible. An alarm inhibit icon appears in the upper right corner or
right center of a parameter box if an alarm limit is set to OFF. The
alarm inhibit icon is red with a white X indicating that an alarm is
turned OFF.
ECG BOX

HR

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The numerical parameter box area is directly to the right of the


waveform area. The area is broken into seven numerical boxes.
There are three additional numerical boxes below the waveforms.
The numerical parameter boxes display the measured value of the
vital sign being monitored, the unit of measure, and parameterdependent information (such as the source for the heart rate or
inspired/expired values for gases).

BPM

-+

60

ECG

The top parameter box, in the upper right hand corner, is dedicated to
display the heart rate. The source of the heart rate (i.e. ECG, IBP,
SpO2, or NIBP) is shown in the lower left corner of this box. The color
of the numeric display for heart rate matches the color of the
waveform source data.
The right half of the ECG parameter box displays the gating output,
the ECG module battery status, and an icon indicating that the
monitor and remote display are communicating. The color of the
gating icon matches the color of the waveform and numerical data of
the source (i.e., ECG gating reflects the color of the ECG waveform
and numerics).

SpO2

98
RESP

Br/m

20

SPO2 BOX

The SpO2 box displays the oxygen saturation in percent.


RESPIRATION BOX

The Respiration box, to the right of the SpO2 box, displays the
respiration rate.
NOTE: Available on Anesthetic and Anesthetic with Temperature
models only.

CO2
EXP
INS

mmHg

200 ml/min

37

CO2 BOX

This box displays numerical values for expired and inspired CO2. The
label EXP stands for expired (end-tidal) CO2 and INS stands for
inspired CO2. The current Flow Rate is displayed in the upper right
corner.

2 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

GAS BOX

Numeric data for oxygen and agent gases appear in the same box.
The oxygen value is listed first followed by the primary halogenated
agent and nitrous oxide concentrations. The top line lists expired
values and the second line lists inspired values. Values are always
INS
Mixed ENF EXP10.5 INS10.0 shown in percent. An alarm inhibit icon displays to the right of each
header to indicate alarm limits set to OFF.
GAS
%
EXP

O2

17
21

HAL

N2O

0.4 39
2.3 64

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The label Mixed appears before secondary agent concentrations


listed at the bottom of the gas parameter box. This indicates that
more than one agent is detected in the system and measures the
secondary agent detected. The abbreviated name of the secondary
agent is located after the Mixed label.
The label Wrong appears before secondary agent concentrations
listed at the bottom of the gas parameter box. The system detects an
agent other than one set in the configuration of the system. If using
more than one agent, set the Agent to Monitor selection in the
PARAMS menu to Auto. The abbreviated name of the secondary
agent is located after the Wrong label.
If the internal gas features are shut off in the PARAMS menu, the
displayed values are replaced by the word OFF in each location.
IBP BOXES

mmHg

IBP1 ART
AR

145/105

(125)
mmHg

IBP2 CVP

13)

The monitor displays the systolic, diastolic, and mean pressure


pulsatile waveforms. The systolic and diastolic values are shown in
large text. The mean value (MAP) is displayed below the systolic and
diastolic values in smaller characters. All MAP values are shown in
parenthesis.
Non-pulsatile waveforms have only a mean value. Non-pulsatile
waveforms mean values are shown in large text and are centered in
the box.

2 10

2 Monitor Setup

NIBP BOX
NIBP

AGE

21:13 min

149/106

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

CYCLE

(127)
MAP

OFF

The NIBP numerical box is located near the center of the screen
below the waveforms. It displays the systolic, diastolic, and mean
pressure after a NIBP reading has completed. The systolic and
diastolic values are shown in large text. The mean value (MAP) is
displayed to the right of the systolic and diastolic values in smaller
characters. MAP values are shown in parenthesis.
When there is no valid reading, dashes are displayed. A valid reading
is dashed after 30 minutes. If a valid reading is displayed, the age of
the reading is displayed. After 30 minutes the age of the
measurement goes to dashes; if there is no valid reading, the age
also appears as dashes.

NIBP

AGE

21:13 min

149/106

CYCLE

4:00:00

T1
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

mmHg

T2

mmHg

(127)
ET

MAP
3:45:37

96.4
97.7

F
F

Main Menu

If a cycle time is set, the interval is displayed. Otherwise the cycle


time displays the word OFF in the NIBP box. If a cycle time is active,
the amount of time remaining (ET) until the next NIBP reading is
scheduled is displayed at the bottom right of the box.
TEMPERATURE BOXES

The top temperature numerical box is dedicated to temperature


channel 1. The lower box is dedicated to channel 2. The units (F or
C) appear in the upper right corner of each box.
The main menu area is directly under the Temperature and NIBP
boxes on the left-hand side of the screen. There are up to eight
selectable soft keys located on the screen as shown below.
NOTE: The Veris 8600 screen layout depends on the configuration of
the monitor.

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-5: Main Menu


One of the eight softkeys is always highlighted. If the user pushes the
menu knob the menu window associated with the highlighted softkey
is displayed and the menu knob control goes to that new window.
Different soft keys are selected by turning the menu knob clockwise
or counterclockwise until the desired key is highlighted.
ZERO IP1 and ZERO IP2 do not access settings windows. On units
without IBP the ZERO IP1 and ZERO IP2 boxes are blank.
More information about the soft keys and their function is explained in
Softkey Functions (Main Menu) on page 2-14.

2 11

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Alarm and Message Areas

The two alarm lines are located under the NIBP numerical box. All
alarm and error messages for NIBP, respiration, and temperature are
displayed in this area. ECG, SpO2, CO2, O2, N2O, Agent, and IBP
high and medium alarms are displayed here if there is not an active
waveform associated with them. All low level messages are displayed
in the top alarm line. The bottom line is for informational messages
and advisory level alerts only.
The informational, low, and medium level alarm warnings are colored
yellow and the high alarm warning messages are red. For more
information about alarms see Alarm Description on page 3-1.

System Status Box

The system status box is located directly below the two lines reserved
for alarms and messages.
BATTERY WARNING ICONS

+-

There is space reserved for two battery icons. The battery icons
represent the state of the internal rechargeable batteries. See
Battery Indicators on page 2-2 and Charging the Battery on
page 2-1 for a complete description of the icons and battery charging.
PATIENT SIZE MODE

The next item in the status line is the patient mode. This message lets
the user know what the patient size or mode the system is in: ADULT,
PEDIATRIC, or NEONATE. The default physiological alarm limits may
change depending on which mode is currently in use.
Patient Information and Clock

A Patient Information Bar runs along the bottom of the display. This
area displays the last name (12 characters), the first name (10
characters) and middle initial (one character) of the patient, the
hospital identification number for the patient (16 characters), and the
patients room number (five characters).
A clock appears to the extreme right of the patient information. This
displays both current date and time.

2 12

2 Monitor Setup

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Keypad

There are nine keypad buttons, including the ON/OFF button and the
eight dedicated function keys. Some of the keys have two functions.
The primary function is activated with a momentary press of the key.
A secondary function, if present, is activated when the key is pressed
and held for two seconds.
Key

Function

On/Off

Power button. Press to activate the patient monitor


and press and hold to turn the monitor off.

Freeze

A single press of this key freezes all waveforms on


the screen. Numeric data continues to be updated for
monitored parameters.
A second press of this key resumes continuous
waveform display.

NIBP Cycle/Stat Press the key momentarily to display the NIBP cycle
popup menu on the screen.
Press and hold this key to begin a Stat measurement.

NIBP

NIBP measurement start key.


Press the key again to cancel an NIBP measurement.

Print

Press once to begin printing or for serial output.


Press a second time to stop printing.

Silence

Press this key momentarily to begin a 2 minute alarm


silence.
Press and hold the key to permanently silence the
alarms.
Press the key again, a second time, to resume
normal alarms.

Default

Press this key momentarily to access custom default


profiles.
Press and hold the key to alter custom default profiles
(password MEDRAD required).

Trend

Displays the trend table when pressed momentarily.


Press the key to exit the trend window.
While the trend table displays, press and hold to
access the trend settings menu.

Stand By

Press this key momentarily to enter standby mode.


Press the key again to exit the standby mode.

When any of the keys is pressed once, a single audible beep notifies
the user that a primary function has been activated. When a key is
pressed and held a double beep notifies the user that a secondary
function is selected.

2 13

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Softkey Functions
(Main Menu)

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-6: Main Screen Menu

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Softkeys are selected by turning the menu knob clockwise or


counterclockwise until the desired softkey is highlighted. In the
sample below the ALARMS softkey is highlighted indicating that the
alarm settings window displays if the menu knob is pressed.

If the menu knob is rotated, any window associated with the


highlighted softkey is displayed when the menu knob is pressed. The
menu knob then controls scrolling through that new menu window.
NOTE: For monitors without invasive blood pressure the two softkeys
at the right end of the main menu are disabled and blank. The
invasive blood pressure zero buttons do not activate windows.
The top item (EXIT) on each menu window automatically highlights
when the window is activated. The user may simply press the menu
knob a second time to exit each window without making changes.
At the bottom of the first window there may be selections allowing
access to subordinate windows. Some windows and settings
discussed in this manual may not be present if the feature is not
installed in the monitor. If an alarm has been turned OFF in the
PARAMS window, settings in other windows, such as alarm limits,
may be disabled.
Changing Settings

Turn the menu knob to highlight items on these menu windows. Press
the menu knob to select the item. A single short beep is generated.
The key press beep is audible even when alarms are silenced.
Some of the settings require a letter or number to be entered. Rotate
the menu knob to select the desired character. Press the menu knob
to select the character.
If an error is made while entering in the ADM/DIS screen, a left arrow
character can be selected in order to back over the existing text. The
down arrow character can be selected to jump to the next line.
The arrow characters are not available when entering passwords.

2 14

2 Monitor Setup

Saved Setting Profiles

Alarms and parameter default settings may be independently


modified as part of a customized default profile. Setting changes
generally remain after the monitor is power cycled.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Changes made to the settings remain in current memory until a


patient is discharged or the monitor is left without power.
If the monitor loses its current setting it returns to the last profile
selected from the memory. If no profile has ever been selected,
the initial profile is CUSTOM DEFAULTS and begins with the
same settings as the Factory Default Settings listed in Factory
Defaults on page 2-39.
The permanent Factory Default profile can be accessed and
restored in the CONFIG window.
The user defined profiles can be accessed and restored by
pressing the DEFAULT key.
Making and saving settings profiles is described later in this manual.
Also see Unit and Configuration Defaults in Appendix B for
instructions for loading CONFIGURATION defaults (Base System,
Cardiac System or Anesthesia System, depending upon your units
configuration).

2 15

MEDRAD Veris 8600

ALARMS Softkey

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Figure 2-7: ALARMS Softkey Selected


This softkey allows access to all the parameter alarm settings. When
the menu is activated by pressing the menu knob, an alarm limit
settings window appears. The alarm window appears as the Adult,
Pediatric, or Neonate window as set in the third item Patient size.
EXIT
Alarm Volume
ECG Lead Fail
Patient size
Heart Rate
SpO2
NIBP Systolic
NIBP Diastolic
NIBP Mean
Temperature 1
Temperature 2
Respiration
CO2 Ins
CO2 Exp
O2 Ins
O2 Exp
Apnea

F
F
mmHg
mmHg
%
%

Other Alarms

5
MEDIUM
Adult
HIGH
LOW
150
40
OFF
90
200
50
100
30
150
50
100.0
93.0
100.0
93.0
36
OFF
10
5
55
20
100
18
100
OFF
20 seconds
No Action

Figure 2-8: Alarm Settings Window (Adult)


The pediatric and adult settings initially are identical, as factory
defaults, but can be adjusted independently and saved as desired.
EXIT
Alarm Volume
ECG Lead Fail
Patient size
Heart Rate
SpO2
NIBP Systolic
NIBP Diastolic
NIBP Mean
Temperature 1
Temperature 2
Respiration
CO2 Ins
CO2 Exp
O2 Ins
O2 Exp
Apnea

F
F
mmHg
mmHg
%
%

Other Alarm Setups

5
MEDIUM
Neonate
HIGH
180
OFF
140
80
100
100.0
100.0
60
10
55
100
100
20 seconds

LOW
90
90
35
30
35
93.0
93.0
14
5
20
18
OFF

No Action

Figure 2-9: Alarm Settings Window (Neonate)

2 16

2 Monitor Setup

Primary ALARMS Window

ALARM VOLUME

The alarm volume can be set from 1 to 10. If the volume is set to 1 it
returns as 2 if the monitor is power cycled. To turn off the alarms use
the SILENCE key. See Alarms and Messages in Section 3 for more
information about alarms.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

ECG LEAD FAIL

This is an adjustable alarm level setting for a condition where the


monitor cannot detect connected ECG leads. Set this according to
the protocols of the facility or to the specific patient need.
ALARMS SETTINGS BY PATIENT SIZE

The monitor retains separate alarm settings for three different patient
sizes. When the patient size mode is changed to Adult, Pediatric, or
Neonate, the monitor recalls alarm limit settings specific to each
patient size.
The extended alarm limit windows for the optional features also have
size specific versions. As in the main screen, the pediatric alarm
settings are the same as adult in the Factory Default profile.
To set all the alarm limits, adjust the settings as necessary including
the extended windows that appear under Other Alarm Setups. Then
change to the next patient size and adjust the settings again including
the extended windows. Repeat setting changes as necessary for
each patient size.
ALARM LIMITS

Alarms activate when a high alarm limit is exceeded or the measured


value drops below a low alarm limit. High and Low limit values can be
set to the same values. In such a case the monitor alarms when any
value but the selected value is measured.

CAUTION !

Turning an alarm limit off disables both the audible and visual
portion of the alarm.
Some alarms automatically reset when the monitor is power
cycled. See Alarms at Start Up on page 3-3 for details.
The low limit alarm can never be set higher than the high limit alarm.
The high limit adjustment is similarly restricted. When adjusting limit
values some of the range may not be available because the monitor
does not display ranges beyond the point that the other limit is set.
Alarm limits cannot be changed for monitoring modules that are
turned off. If an alarm limit cannot be selected, check the PARAMS
menu to confirm the module is turned on.

2 17

MEDRAD Veris 8600

OTHER ALARM SETUPS

Activation of the Other Alarm Setups option at the bottom of the first
alarms window may reveal additional alarms screens if other
parameter modules are detected when the system is powered up.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Invasive Blood Pressure


Alarm Settings

This selection is not available in Base or BasePlus configurations.


Select Inv. BP Setup to view the window. Alarm limits can be set by
IBP channel or by IBP site location.
EXIT

IBP 1
IBP 2

Systolic
HIGH LOW
200
50

Default Alarm Limits by Site


Systolic
HIGH LOW
ART
200
50
PA
40
15
LV
200
60
RV
50
20
LA
RA
CVP
ICP
<<< BACK

Diastolic
HIGH LOW
100
30

Mean
HIGH LOW
150
50
15
1

Diastolic
HIGH LOW
100
30
15
5
40
0
20
0

Mean
HIGH LOW
150
50
20
10
120
60
30
10
15
1
15
1
15
1
15
1

Figure 2-10: IBP Alarm Settings Window


The alarm limits in effect (current) are the two IBP channels shown at
the top of the screen. These can be set to pulsatile or non-pulsatile
sites. The limits at the bottom of the screen are used if the IBP site
location is changed in the PARAMS window.
The site alarm limits are for defaults settings only. Invasive blood
pressure for LA, RA, CVP, and ICP are non-pulsatile and do not
report values for systolic and diastolic pressure.

2 18

2 Monitor Setup

Agent Gas Alarms


EXIT

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Agent
N2O

Inspired
HIGH
LOW
2.3
OFF
75
OFF

Expired
HIGH
LOW
1.5
OFF
OFF
OFF

Default Alarm Limits by Agent


Inspired
Expired
HIGH
LOW
HIGH
LOW
HAL
2.3
OFF
1.5
OFF
ENF
4.8
OFF
3.2
OFF
ISO
3.6
OFF
2.4
OFF
DES
18.0
OFF
12.0
OFF
SEV
5.1
OFF
3.4
OFF

<<< BACK

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure 2-11: Agent Gas Alarm Setting Window


This selection is only available in Anesthetic and Anesthetic with
Temperature configurations. Select Agent Setup from Other Alarm
Setups to view the window shown above.
The agent alarm window appears initially the same for adult,
pediatric, and neonate mode. Agent alarm limits can be set
independently and saved, or stored as defaults if desired.
Any changes made are saved immediately to current memory.
PRIMARY HALOGENATED AGENT ALARM LIMITS

The first setting of the agent alarm window is the primary


halogenated alarm limits. The primary agent is determined in the
PARAMS menu and is discussed later in this section.
The settings for the current primary agent can be changed in the
PARAMS menu. If the primary agent is changed, the corresponding
limits for the new primary agent are applied from the default alarm
limits listed for each specific gas. Each time the primary agent gas is
changed any previous changes made directly to the first setting
primary agent are lost.
NOTE: Parameter limit alarms for the remaining four monitored nonprimary agents are not active even though their numerical values may
appear on the main screen as a mixed (secondary) agent. Any
halogenated agent not designated or determined as the primary
agent (that exceeds its threshold limit) is treated as a component of a
mixed gas for alarm purposes.

2 19

MEDRAD Veris 8600

NITROUS OXIDE ALARM LIMITS

The second setting is for the nitrous oxide (N2O) alarm limits.
MONITORED HALOGENATED AGENTS

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The Veris 8600 monitor provides alarm limit settings for halothane,
enflurane, isoflurane, desflurane and sevoflurane. Only one of these
five monitored gases has active alarm limits depending on which has
been designated or automatically determined as the primary agent
for monitoring.
The anesthetic agents go by other names, as shown in the table
below. It is the responsibility of the physician to correctly recognize
and administer anesthetic gases. The Veris 8600 monitor uses
international standard abbreviations, also shown in the table below.

Generic Agent Name

Alternate Agent Name

International
Standard
Abbreviation

Halothane

Fluothane

HAL

Enflurane

Ethrane

ENF

Isoflurane

Forane

ISO

Desflurane

Suprane

DES
SEV

Sevoflurane

2 20

2 Monitor Setup

PARAMS Softkey
(Physiological Parameters)

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-12: PARAMS Softkey Selected

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

When this softkey is activated a parameter settings window appears.


This softkey allows access to the physiological parameter settings.
Each of the sampling modules is listed here and can be turned on
and off. Gaps may appear in the menu if features are not installed.
EXIT
HR Source
Gating
ECG
Cable
Filter
Display Range
Auto lead switching
Color
IBP 1
IBP 2

Smart
OFF
ON
5 lead
Monitor
MEDIUM
YES

SITE ART RANGE 0 TO 200


SITE CVP RANGE 0 TO 20

ZERO None Color


ZERO None Color

NIBP
NIBP tone
Color

ON
NONE

ECG/IBP/SPO2 Tone Vol


Other Params Menus

5
No Action

GASES

ON

Figure 2-13: Parameter Window


Selecting Other Params Menus activates additional windows:
SPO2, RESP, TEMP Menu
Gas Menu
Primary PARAMS Window

MONITORING MODULE ON/OFF SELECTION

Each monitoring module (SpO2, ECG, NIBP, IBP, Temperature, Gas,


and Respiration) can be turned OFF or ON in the PARAMS softkey
window. The waveforms, numerical parameters, and messages for
that module do not display. The audible alarms associated with that
module are also disabled. The ON/OFF setting or absence of a
monitoring module can also affect the Smart Heart Rate function.
COLOR SETTINGS

At the end of some monitoring module settings, Color appears to the


right with color samples. The color sample indicates the current color
selected for the display of the numerical values and waveforms for the
monitoring module. The numerical values and the waveforms always
have matching colors with the exception of the breath by breath
display, which is always in white.

2 21

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The colors can be changed as desired. Select the color setting to


access the color sample box. Turn the knob to scroll through the
possible colors and press the knob to enter the selection. The colors
red, yellow, blue, green, orange, violet, light gold, and white may be
selected.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

SMART HEART RATE

When Smart is selected for HR Source, the monitor generates a


numerical heart rate value from the remaining operating modules if a
higher lever module is turned off or lost. If the ECG signal is lost or
turned off, the monitor automatically switches to another available
source. The order is:
ECG
IBP
SpO2
NIBP
The monitor generates a heart rate from the ECG module, the IBP
module, the SpO2 module, or from the NIBP (in that order of
preference). The NIBP heart rate is updated with each NIBP
measurement rather than being continuously updated with the ECG,
IBP, or SpO2 waveform data. When the heart rate is based on NIBP
data the numerical heart rate value is removed 2 minutes after the
last NIBP measurement was completed.
If a specific parameter is selected for HR Source, and that parameter
is lost, the monitor does not switch to another parameter for the heart
rate.
GATING

The gating function can be set to OFF, ECG Wave, SpO2 Wave, ECG
Pulse, or SpO2 Pulse.
ECG CABLE

The monitor can be set to 3 lead or 5 lead ECG.


NOTE: Base and BasePlus models only have 3 lead capabilities.

2 22

2 Monitor Setup

ECG FILTER

The ECG Filter function has several settings in which to choose from
in real-time.
Monitor
MR1
MR2
MR3

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MR4
MR5
MR6
MR7
The Monitor setting allows the received ECG signal on the monitor
display to meet the EC13 requirements as stated in ECG in
Section 5 and Specifications in Appendix C.
It may be necessary to select other filter settings in real-time on the
monitor display during MRI scanning when using the ECG function.
These settings optimally filter noise in the ECG signal caused by the
static and gradient magnetic fields of the MRI Scanner.
To select filters:
1. Turn menu knob to highlight PARAMS softkey. Press menu
knob to activate.
2. Turn menu knob to highlight filter. Press menu knob.
3. Turn menu knob to select desired filter in real-time. Observe the
ECG waveform in top slot on the monitor display during
selection. Press menu knob when satisfied.
DISPLAY RANGE

This setting controls the ECG signal gain. If it is set too high, the signal
may exceed the valid range for monitoring. The high level alarm
message ECG: SENS TOO HIGH displays. If this occurs, lower the
sensitivity setting. For general monitoring use the medium setting.
ECG AUTO LEAD SWITCH

The PARAMS window settings for Auto Lead Switching are described
in ECG Auto Lead Switching on page 5-16. For general use, these
can both be set to the On position.

2 23

MEDRAD Veris 8600

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

IBP SETTINGS

The two IBP channels can be configured separately. The choices are:
Arterial (ART),
Pulmonary Artery (PA),
Left Atrial (LA),
Right Atrial (RA),
Central Venous (CVP),
Right Ventricle (RV),
Left Ventricle (LV),
Intracranial (ICP), or
Off.
The ranges for IBP waveform display are also independently
selectable.
The IBP channels can be zeroed using the setting from the PARAMS
window or from the main menu softkey, whichever is more
convenient.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

IBP AUTO-RANGING

The monitor provides auto-ranging for each IBP channel individually.


When auto-ranging is selected for a channel in the PARAMS window,
the monitor determines the best display range based on previous
extremes of the waveform.
The scale changes to exceed the waveform maximums by at least 5
mmHg. The auto-ranging occurs when the PARAMS window is
exited. If the past extremes of the waveforms are exceeded, clipping
occurs. The new range remains until auto ranging is selected again or
specific range values are set in the PARAMS window.
NIBP SETTINGS

The NIBP can be set to generate a tone upon completion of each


measurement.
NOTE: Press the NIBP CYCLE/STAT key to access the cycle
settings.
HEART RATE TONE VOLUME

This feature can be set at the bottom of the first PARAMS window.
The tone can be set to volumes 1 through 10 or OFF. This setting only
controls the tone volume associated with the heart rate rhythm. It is
not affected by adjustments to Alarm Volume or the SILENCE feature.

2 24

2 Monitor Setup

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

SpO2, Respiration,
Temperature Menu

<<<Exit
SpO2
Average
Search time
Low limit alarm
Color

ON
12 seconds
20 seconds
HIGH

Respiration

ON

Temperature 1
Temperature 2
Unit of measure
Color

ON
ON
F

<<<Back?

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure 2-14: SpO2, Respiration, Temperature Parameter


Window
SPO2 SETTINGS

There are three settings specific to the SpO2 module; Average,


Search Time, and Low Limit Alarm.
SpO2 Average sets the duration of the interval over which the SpO2
value is averaged. The settings for each are listed in seconds.
SpO2 Search Time sets the time interval from the time the pulse signal
is lost until the SpO2 SEARCH message appears.
The SpO2 Low Limit Alarm can be set to either high or medium priority
as desired. The monitor generates an alarm of that level when the low
limit threshold is passed.
RESPIRATION

Respiration is only available if the Veris monitor has CO2 (Anesthetic


and Anesthetic with Temperature models only). The source is always
CO2.
TEMPERATURE SETTINGS

The temperature channels can be turned ON or OFF and can be set


to read in either Celsius (C) or Fahrenheit (F).

2 25

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Gas Settings

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

EXIT
CO2
Unit of measure
Color

ON
mmHg

O2
Color

ON

Agent
Agent to Monitor
Flow Rate
Flow Mode
Agent Color
N2O Color

Automatic Selection
200 ml/min
Exhaust

<<< BACK

Figure 2-15: Gas Settings

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

CO2 UNIT OF MEASURE

The CO2 numerical data can be displayed as mm/hg, Torr, kPa, or


volume percent.
AGENT TO MONITOR

The primary agent for monitoring must be correctly entered


depending on the monitoring alarm characteristic desired by the user.
The monitor has two modes of agent gas monitoring. The user may
select a specific halogenated agent to be designated as the primary
agent. The user may otherwise set the monitor to automatically
detect and identify the current primary gas of a mixture.
NOTE: If the user manually selects the primary agent for monitoring it
must be correctly entered.

WARNING !

Always confirm the primary agent selection before use.


Incorrect primary agent setting may result in erroneous limit
alarms. Alarm characteristics of the monitor are altered when
automatic primary agent detection is activated.
Never substitute a primary agent setting for a different
halogenated agent, or any agent not listed! The agent detection
is specific to the listed gases only.
The alarm WRONG AGENT appears when the primary agent
(that is manually selected by the physician) does not match the
primary agent detected. The WRONG AGENT alarm is
deactivated when automatic primary agent detection is
selected.

2 26

2 Monitor Setup

WARNING !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The halogenated agent waveform and waveform label may


automatically change to a different halogenated agent when
automatic primary agent detection is used. If no primary agent
is detected, dashes appear in the waveform label when
automatic primary agent detection is used.
The primary agent is the halogenated agent having the highest
concentration during mixed gas conditions. Where only one
halogenated agent is to be used, the single agent should always be
the primary agent. The primary agent can be set to halothane,
isoflurane, enflurane, desflurane, sevoflurane, or automatic.
The selected primary halogenated agent has its own set of alarm
limits as described earlier in this section. This is for use when the
primary agent is selected manually. When automatic primary agent
detection is used, the agent alarm limits are updated at the time of
identification from the Default Alarm Limits by Agent settings. If the
primary agent is redefined automatically, the alarm limits are again
updated from the agent specific limits defined in the menu.
FLOW RATE

The Flow Rate setting adjusts the amount of air that is drawn in by the
gas monitoring system. The monitor provides accurate values in
either 100, 150, or 200 ml/min settings. It is recommended that the
200 ml/min setting be used for better response time.
FLOW MODE

The flow mode of the Veris monitor is permanently set to exhaust and
cannot be changed.

2 27

MEDRAD Veris 8600

DISPLAY Softkey

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-16: DISPLAY Softkey Selected

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

This softkey allows access to the display settings. When activated,


the display settings window appears. The monitor can display up to
six waveforms and has user selectable waveform slot configurations.
See Waveform Slots on page 2-6 for a list of displayed waveforms.
EXIT
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform

1
2
3
4
5
6

TYPE

GAIN

ECG II
OFF
ECG I
PLETH
aVL
aVR

x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

External Display

SWEEP
MM/S
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0

SIZE
50mm
25mm
25mm
12mm
12mm
12mm

OFF

Figure 2-17: Display Settings Window


Waveform Description

The waveform area is located in the upper left-hand portion of the


display. The monitor has the capability to display six waveforms
simultaneously. The top waveform slots 1, 2, and 3 are 25 mm in
height. Waveform slots 4, 5, and 6 are 12.5 mm in height. Slots can
be configured in a variety of ways as described in the following text.
The waveforms may be adjusted in size and dimension by using the
settings provided. The gain listed on the DISPLAY window settings
increases the display size of the waveforms. It does not control the
amplification gain of the source signal or the height of the slot where
the waveform appears.
The parameters for the waveforms displayed are user selectable with
the exception of the first slot, which is always an ECG waveform. The
user can select which lead to display for the ECG waveform in the
first slot.

2 28

2 Monitor Setup

Double Height Slots

The monitor can display waveforms in three 25mm slots and three
smaller 12.5mm slots.
Two 25mm slots can be combined to form one 50mm slot.
Two 12.5mm slots in the, bottom group, can be combined
together to form one 25mm slot.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

No more than two slots can be combined to form a larger


waveform display area
NOTE: Slots 3 and 4 cannot be combined.
EXIT
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform

1
2
3
4
5
6

TYPE

GAIN

ECG II
OFF
ECG aVR
PLETH
OFF
ET CO2

x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0

External Display

SWEEP
MM/S
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0

SIZE
50mm
25mm
25mm
25mm
12mm
12mm

OFF

Figure 2-18: Display Settings Window with Combined


Slots
HR

BPM

ECG
IBP1 ART

x1

mmHg

145/105

(125)

1mV
aVR

IBP2

mmHg

CVP

13

x2
SpO2

RESP

SpO2

98

x1

GAS
%
E

CO2
T1

-+

60

1mV
II

96.4
97.7

NIBP

AGE

21:13 min

mmHg

O2

Br/m

20

CO2
HAL

17 0.4
21 2.3

N2O

39
64

I
Mixed ENF E 10.5 I 10.0
150 ml/min
MAP CO2
T2
CYCLE OFF
EXP
SPO2:
SENSOR
ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1
V000 - NO ADMIT INS
8
ZERO IP2 - + - + Adult
ADM/DIS CONFIG PRINT
AUG-16-04
14:12:59

149/106 (127)

37

Figure 2-19: Double Height Slots


To combine slots to form larger areas to display waveforms set the
lower slot TYPE to OFF. The slot above automatically increases in
size to fill the space.

2 29

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Each waveform slot displays the parameter or source along the left
edge of the screen. The colors of the waveforms are user selectable
in the PARAMS window. The numerical parameters colors match the
selected waveform color whenever possible.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Cascaded Slots

The monitor can cascade a waveform into the next lower slot and it is
then displayed as twice or three times its original length.
The cascaded data is a continuous band of waveform using the
sweep speed as set in the original waveform slot. The gain and range
settings are the same for the entire cascaded waveform. The
waveform label and scale are not shown for slots where data has
been cascaded from a higher slot.
EXIT
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform
Waveform

1
2
3
4
5
6

TYPE

GAIN

ECG II
Cascade
ECG aVR
PLETH
Cascade
Cascade

x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0
x1.0

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

External Display

SWEEP
MM/S
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0

SIZE
25mm
25mm
25mm
12mm
12mm
12mm

OFF

Figure 2-20: Display Window, Cascaded Slots


HR

1mV
II

BPM

-+

60

ECG
GAS
%
E

x1

O2

HAL

N2O

17 0.4
21 2.3

39
64

I
Mixed ENF E 10.5 I 10.0
CO2
150 ml/min

1mV
aVR

37
8

EXP

x2

INS

SpO2

RESP

SpO2

98

20
CO2
mmHg

IBP1 ART
T1
T2

96.4
97.7

NIBP

AGE

21:13 min

mmHg

149/106 (127)

MAP
CYCLE OFF
SPO2:
SENSOR
ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1
V000 - NO ADMIT
ZERO IP2 - + - + Adult
ADM/DIS CONFIG PRINT

145/105

(125)

IBP2

CVP

mmHg

13
AUG-16-04

Figure 2-21: Cascaded Slots

2 30

Br/m

14:12:59

2 Monitor Setup

To cascade a waveform into the next lower slot, set the lower slot
TYPE to CASCADE. The waveform above automatically cascades
into the next lower slot. You can cascade slots 1-2-3, or slots 4-5-6.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: The display is set up in separate groups of three slots so a


waveform cannot be cascaded from slot 3-4.
Cascade and the double height feature can be applied to the upper
and lower groups of slots independently. It is also not possible to
cascade (double height) waveforms.
Gain and Sweep

The GAIN and SWEEP settings found in the DISPLAY menu can also
be used to modify the way waveforms are displayed on the screen.
The upper three (25mm) slots of the display allow for larger
waveforms to display. Gain settings from the upper set of slots do not
correspond to the gain settings of the lower three slots. In order to
obtain identical waveform sizes in the top and bottom slots, set the
gain of the lower three slots one step higher than the top three slots.
A minimum of four and a half seconds worth of data at a sweep speed
of 25mm per second is displayed. Waveforms can have sweep
speeds of 50, 25, 12.5 or 6.25 mm per second.

2 31

MEDRAD Veris 8600

ADM/DIS Softkey (Admit/


Discharge)

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-22: ADM/DIS Softkey Selected

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

A patient may be admitted or discharged in the ADM/DIS window,


however it is only necessary to correctly specify the Patient Size
since this adjusts the monitoring defaults.
EXIT
Admit
Discharge
Patient Size
Update

NO
NO
Adult
NO

Last Name
First Name
Middle Initial
Room Number
ID Number
Unit Label

xxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxx
x
xxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
000

Figure 2-23: Admit/Discharge Window


NOTE: Patient Size can be also set in the ALARMS window. This is
the same setting and it can be changed in either location.
NOTE: The Unit Label is for future use.
Admitting and
Discharging Patients

CAUTION !

It is recommended that the admit and discharge feature be used


between each patient so that there is a clear break between
patient histories in the memory. This also ensures that label
headers are properly printed out for each patient.
It is possible to admit a blank patient. If this is done, there is no
patient data label on printed reports. Data from various patients
could appear to merge together onto one trend table or graph.
It is not necessary to admit a patient for the monitor to function
properly. There is no audible alarm for the no admit condition.
A message appears in the informational message box indicating
that no patient has been admitted.

2 32

2 Monitor Setup

CAUTION !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The discharge feature returns the monitor to the user default


profile last selected. If no user profiles have ever been selected
on a new monitor the CUSTOM DEFAULTS found in the first
position in the defaults window is used.
Adult/Pediatric/Neonatal
(Patient Size)

The monitor is designed to look at the Patient Size information


selected in the ADM/DIS window and determine whether the monitor
should use the Adult, Pediatric, or Neonatal alarm settings while
monitoring.
The patient mode is determined by patient size and is displayed in the
System Status Line.
When Patient Size is changed in the ADM/DIS window, the monitor
determines which window appears when the ALARMS softkey is
selected. By changing Patient Size, the user effectively changes all
the alarm limits for all the monitoring modules. The Patient Size
setting also adjusts the maximum NIBP pressure limit. For Adult and
Pediatric the limit is 300 mmHg. The limit for Neonate is 150 mmHg.

Patient Information

To enter, change, or update patient information:


1. Set the menu to ADM/DIS and press the knob.
2. Go to Patient Size and check that it is correct. Change to Adult,
Pediatric, or Neonate as necessary.
3. Turn the knob to Update and set to YES. Press the knob. The
patient data field can now be selected.
4. Go to the patient name and identity fields. Turn the knob to
select the desired field. Press the knob to go to the blank line.
Turn the knob to select the correct letter.
NOTE: Letters and digits may be entered using the rotary knob.
Two arrow characters also appear among the letters and digits.
Selecting the back arrow allows corrections to be made. The
down arrow skips directly to the next line when finished entering
a line.
5. Fill in the remaining patient information blanks as desired.
6. Select EXIT to return to the main screen. The patient data is
updated on the main screen.
7. Exit the ADM/DIS window and re-enter before attempting to
admit a patient.

2 33

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Procedure for
Admitting a Patient

To admit a patient, proceed as follows:


1. Set the menu to ADM/DIS and press the knob. the ADM/DIS
window appears. If the patient data needs to be updated use the
patient information procedure.
2. Rotate the knob to highlight Admit. The admit selection is not
available if a patient has already been admitted.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3. Press the knob to select Admit. Turn the knob to YES. The
message NEW PATIENT is also entered into the trend memory.
NOTE: If there is no patient data a blank patient is admitted.
4. Turn the knob back to EXIT to return to the main screen, or
proceed to update patient information.
Procedure for
Discharging a Patient

To discharge a patient, proceed as follows:


1. Set the menu to ADM/DIS and press the knob. the ADM/DIS
window appears.
2. Rotate the knob to highlight Discharge. The discharge selection
is not available if a patient has not been admitted.
3. Press the knob to select Discharge. Turn the knob to YES.
4. The monitor responds with a confirmation screen.
5. Turn the knob to YES and press to confirm.
6. The monitor clears the patient data fields and returns the
monitor to the last user default profile that was selected.
7. The monitor enters Standby Mode (or Agent Standby Mode if
the monitor has anesthetic options).
NOTE: The monitor enters Standby Mode after a patient is
discharged so that the monitor does not record extraneous data
into the trend memory while sensors and electrodes are
removed from the patient. The message NEW PATIENT is also
entered into the trend memory at the point of discharge.
8. Press the orange STAND BY key to return to the main screen.

2 34

2 Monitor Setup

CONFIG Softkey
(System Configuration)

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-24: CONFIG Softkey Selected

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

This softkey allows access to the configuration settings. When


activated a configuration settings window appears.

EXIT
Date Format
Date
DAY 10
Time
Freeze timeout
Standby timeout
Standby tone
Alarm tone warning
Print Device
Language
Line Frequency
Serial

Format

DD-MM-YYYY
MONTH JUL
YEAR 2004
17:47
2 minutes
30 minutes
ON
ON
Internal Printer
ENGLISH
60
CUSP

Analog Out Select


Restore Factory Defaults
Enter Service Mode
Enter Simulation Mode
Enter Network Config

Baudrate

HISPD

ECG I
NO
NO
NO
NO

Figure 2-25: System Configuration Window


This window contains settings that are related to the general function
of the overall monitor. The window also has some settings that may
affect physiological monitoring.
!

CAUTION !

The Alarm Tone Warning and Standby Timeout settings can


permanently disable alarm functions. See ECG in Section 5 for
more information on Alarms.
The Line Frequency setting affects the SpO2 filter function.
The Return to Factory Defaults setting may make changes
affecting all of the physiological monitoring modules.
The printing and communications settings are discussed in Printing
and Data Ports on page 12-1 of this manual. Service mode and
Simulation Mode are described in the Veris 8600 Service Manual.

2 35

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Password Protection

Date Format

Several settings on the CONFIG and the Enter Network Config


screens are password protected. These are functions that generally
should not be changed during use and their settings should be
adjusted by supervisory personnel, your MEDRAD representative, or
other qualified service personnel. These include; Standby Timeout,
Alarm Tone Warning, Line Frequency, Enter Service Mode, and Enter
Simulation Mode. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative about service passwords.
The date format can be set to display or print Day-Month-Year or
Month-Day-Year.

Time/Date Setting

The Time and Date are set in the CONFIG softkey window. Changing
the time and date while monitoring a patient does not affect the
accurate display of patient data, but it clears any recorded trend data.

Freeze Timeout

The FREEZE function can be set to freeze the waveform frame from
30 seconds to five minutes. Choosing OFF causes the FREEZE key
to hold the screen permanently until the FREEZE key is pressed
again. The FREEZE key also captures waveforms that are obscured
by dialog boxes and pop-up windows. When the FREEZE key is
pressed the waveforms are redrawn on the screen. The FREEZE
function forces an exit from the current pop-up window or dialog box.

Standby Timeout

The Standby Timeout can be set to disable the monitor from 5


minutes to 2 hours. Choosing OFF causes the STAND BY key to
disable the monitor permanently until the STAND BY key is pressed
again. This setting is password protected. The factory default value is
30 minutes.

Standby Tone

When set to ON the monitor produces a single low pitched beep


every minute during Standby Mode. When set to OFF there is no tone
to remind the user that the monitor is in Standby Mode.

Alarm Tone Warning

When set to ON the monitor produces a low pitched double beep


every two minutes during the permanent silence condition. When set
to OFF there is no tone to remind the user that the silence condition
is active.
NOTE: Set this safeguard according to your facility protocols and
according to local safety regulations for medical devices.

Print Device

The print device can be set to Internal Printer, Serial, or OFF.


Set to Internal Printer to print data to the thermal printer on the
optional remote display.
Set to Serial to print to an external printer or download to a
computer.
Set to OFF to disable the printing feature.
See Printing and Data Ports on page 12-1 for more information.

2 36

2 Monitor Setup

Language Settings

The following languages are available in the monitor; ENGLISH,


FRENCH, GERMAN, ITALIAN, SPANISH, JAPANESE, and
PORTUG. (Portuguese).
To change the language:
1. Press the ON/OFF key to start the monitor.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Turn the menu knob until the CONFIG softkey is highlighted.


3. Press the menu knob in to select the CONFIG softkey. The
configuration window appears.
4. Turn the knob until the Language setting is highlighted.
5. Press the knob to select the Language setting. The current
language shown to the right is highlighted.
6. Turn the knob until the desired language appears.
7. Press the knob again to select the new language.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

8. Exit the configuration window.


The language should be properly set when saving user default
profiles. The correct language can then be restored using only the
DEFAULT key and the default profile dialog box when an unfamiliar
language is set on the monitor.
In situations where the monitor has been left for over 24 hours without
power or charged batteries, the Language setting as well as other
defaults may be lost. In this condition the monitor reverts to the
Language set in the last selected user default profile. ENGLISH is the
default language when no other has been selected.

2 37

MEDRAD Veris 8600

PRINT Softkey

ALARMS

PARAMS

DISPLAY

ZERO IP1

ADM/DIS

CONFIG

PRINT

ZERO IP2

Figure 2-26: PRINT Softkey Selected

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: The printer is only found in the remote display. Printer settings
may be adjusted from the main monitor or the remote display.
The PRINT softkey allows access to the printer settings window.

EXIT
Print Type
Alarm Print
BP Print
Interval Print
INTERVAL PRINT TYPE
Snapshot Size
History Size
Waveform 1
Gain
Waveform 2
Gain
Printer Speed

Graphical
OFF
OFF
OFF
TABULAR
6 Seconds
6 Seconds
ECG II
x1.0
Pleth
x1.0
25 mm/sec

Figure 2-27: Print Configuration Window


If the internal thermal printer does not respond, check the CONFIG
menu. The Printer Device must be set to Internal Printer. If the
monitor returns to factory defaults the CONFIG setting returns to
Serial.
The setting Alarm Print causes the monitor to print all parameters
upon the activation of a new high or medium level alarm.
See Printing and Data Ports on page 12-1 for more information on
printing.
TABULAR PRINTING

Numerical values for all current parameters are printed.


GRAPHICAL PRINTING

If both Waveform 1 and 2 have been set to a physical parameter the


print out is a split dual waveform. If only one of the waveforms is
turned on, a single waveform is printed using the entire waveform
area. If both waveforms are turned off, the waveform area of the print
out is blank.

2 38

2 Monitor Setup

Default Settings
Factory Defaults

ALARMS SETTINGS

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Alarm

Type

Range

Adult Pediatric Neonate

Alarm Volume

1-10

ECG lead fail

high, medium, low

medium

medium

medium

Heart Rate
Heart Rate

High
Low

80-250, Off
20-160, Off

150
40

150
40

180
90

SpO2
SpO2

High
Low

70-98, Off
1-98, Off

Off
90

Off
90

Off
90

NIBP Systolic
NIBP Systolic
NIBP Diastolic
NIBP Diastolic
NIBP Mean
NIBP Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

75-240, Off
50-150, Off
50-180, Off
15-50, Off
70-200, Off
25-125, Off

200
50
100
30
150
50

200
50
100
30
150
50

140
35
80
30
100
35

Temperature 1 High
Temperature 1 Low

68.0-111.0F, Off
68.0-111.0F, Off

100.0F
93.0F

100.0F
93.0F

100.0F *
93.0F *

Temperature 2 High
Temperature 2 Low

68.0-111.0F, Off
68.0-111.0F, Off

100.0F
93.0F

100.0F
93.0F

100.0F *
93.0F *

Respiration
Respiration

High
Low

6-120, Off
6-120, Off

36
4

36
4

60
14

CO2 Inspired
CO2 Inspired
CO2 Expired
CO2 Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0-100 mmHg, Off


0-100 mmHg, Off
0-100 mmHg, Off
0-100 mmHg, Off

10 mmHg
5 mmHg
55 mmHg
20 mmHg

10 mmHg
5 mmHg
55 mmHg
20 mmHg

10 mmHg
5 mmHg
55 mmHg
20 mmHg

*
*
*
*

O2 Inspired
O2 Inspired
O2 Expired
O2 Expired

High
Low
High
Low

18-100%, Off
18-100%
18-100%, Off
18-100%, Off

100
18
100
18

100
18
100
18

100
18
100
18

*
*
*
*

5-60, Off

20

20

20

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off

200
50
100
30
150
50

150
50
100
30
150
50

140
50
80
30
100
40

*
*
*
*
*
*

15
1

*
*
*
*
*
*

Apnea
IBP1 Systolic
IBP1 Systolic
IBP1 Diastolic
IBP1 Diastolic
IBP1 Mean
IBP1 Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

IBP2 Systolic
IBP2 Systolic
IBP2 Diastolic
IBP2 Diastolic
IBP2 Mean
IBP2 Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
15
15
-10 to 240, Off
1
1
* Only on units with these parameters.

2 39

*
*

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Alarm

Type

Range

ART Systolic
ART Systolic
ART Diastolic
ART Diastolic
ART Mean
ART Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off

200
50
100
30
150
50

200
50
100
30
150
50

140
50
80
30
100
40

*
*
*
*
*
*

PA Systolic
PA Systolic
PA Diastolic
PA Diastolic
PA Mean
PA Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off

40
15
15
5
20
10

40
15
15
5
20
10

40
15
15
5
20
10

*
*
*
*
*
*

LA Mean
LA Mean

High
Low

-10 to 240, Off


-10 to 240, Off

15
1

15
1

15
1

*
*

LV Systolic
LV Systolic
LV Diastolic
LV Diastolic
LV Mean
LV Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off

200
60
40
0
120
60

0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
0
0

*
*
*
*
*
*

RA Mean
RA Mean

High
Low

-10 to 240, Off


-10 to 240, Off

15
1

15
1

15
1

*
*

RV Systolic
RV Systolic
RV Diastolic
RV Diastolic
RV Mean
RV Mean

High
Low
High
Low
High
Low

0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
0 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off
-10 to 240, Off

50
20
20
0
30
10

0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
0
0

*
*
*
*
*
*

CVP Mean
CVP Mean

High
Low

-10 to 240, Off


-10 to 240, Off

15
1

15
1

15
1

*
*

ICP Mean
ICP Mean

High
Low

-10 to 240, Off


-10 to 240, Off

15
1

15
1

15
1

*
*

Primary InspiredHigh
Primary InspiredLow
Primary ExpiredHigh
Primary ExpiredLow

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

*
*
*
*

N2O Inspired
N2O Inspired
N2O Expired
N2O Expired

20-100%, Off
1-50%, Off
20-100%, Off
1-50%, Off

75
1
20
1

75
1
20
1

75
1
20
1

*
*
*
*

High
Low
High
Low

Adult Pediatric Neonate

* Only on units with these parameters.

2 40

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2 Monitor Setup

Alarm

Type

Range

Adult Pediatric Neonate

HAL Inspired
HAL Inspired
HAL Expired
HAL Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

2.3
0.0
1.5
0.0

*
*
*
*

ENF Inspired
ENF Inspired
ENF Expired
ENF Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

4.8
0.0
3.2
0.0

4.8
0.0
3.2
0.0

4.8
0.0
3.2
0.0

*
*
*
*

ISO Inspired
ISO Inspired
ISO Expired
ISO Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

3.6
0.0
2.4
0.0

3.6
0.0
2.4
0.0

3.6
0.0
2.4
0.0

*
*
*
*

DES Inspired
DES Inspired
DES Expired
DES Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

18.0
0.0
12.0
0.0

18.0
0.0
12.0
0.0

18.0
0.0
12.0
0.0

*
*
*
*

SEV Inspired
SEV Inspired
SEV Expired
SEV Expired

High
Low
High
Low

0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off
0.1-20.0%, Off
0.0-10.0%, Off

5.1
0.0
3.4
0.0

5.1
0.0
3.4
0.0

5.1
0.0
3.4
0.0

*
*
*
*

* Only on units with these parameters.

2 41

MEDRAD Veris 8600

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MONITORING PARAMETERS

Parameter

Selectable Options

Factory Default

HR Source

Smart, ECG, IBP, SPO2, NIBP

Smart

Gating

Off, ECG Wave, SpO2 Wave,


ECG Pulse, SpO2 Pulse

Off *

ECG

On, Off

On

ECG Cable

5 Lead, 3 Lead

3 Lead (Base, BasePlus)


5 Lead (Other models)

ECG Filter

Monitor, MR1, MR2, MR3, MR4,


MR5, MR6, MR7

Monitor

Display Range

High, Medium, Low

Medium

Auto lead switching

Yes, No

Yes

IBP 1 Site

ART, PA, LA, RA, LV, RV,


CVP, ICP, OFF
ART *
-10 to 10, 0 to 20, 0 to 30, 0 to 40,
0 to 60, 0 to 100, 0 to 150, 0 to 200,
0 to 300, and Auto-ranging
0 to 200 *
None, One, All
None *

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

IBP 1 Range

IBP 1 Zero
IBP 2 Site
IBP 2 Range

IBP 2 Zero
NIBP
NIBP Tone
Heart Rate
Tone Volume

ART, PA, LA, RA, LV, RV,


CVP, ICP, OFF
CVP *
-10 to 10, 0 to 20, 0 to 30, 0 to 40,
0 to 60, 0 to 100, 0 to 150, 0 to 200,
0 to 300, and Auto-ranging
0 to 20 *
None, One, All
None *
On, Off
End, None

On
None

1-10, Off

SpO2
SpO2 Average
SpO2 Search Time
SpO2 Low
Limit Alarm

On, Off
3, 6, 9,12,15,18, 21
10, 20, 30, 40

On
12
20

High, Medium

High

Respiration

On, Off

On

Temperature 1
Temperature 2
Unit of measure

On, Off
On, Off
F, C

On *
On *
F *

CO2 Unit of measure Percent, mmHg, KPa, Torr

mmHg *

Agent to Monitor
(Primary)

Halothane, Enflurane, Isoflurane, Automatic *


Desflurane, Sevoflurane, Automatic

Gas Flow Rate


Flow Mode

100, 150, 200 mL


200 mL *
Exhaust
Exhaust *
* Only on units with these parameters.

2 42

2 Monitor Setup

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

CONFIGURATION SETTINGS

Configuration

Selectable Options

Date Format
Date
Time

DD-MM-YYYY; MM-DD-YYYY
Day, Month, Year
Hour, Minute

Freeze Timeout
Standby Timeout
Standby Tone
Alarm Tone Warning

30 seconds, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 minutes, Off 2 min


5, 10, 15, 30, 45 minutes, 1, 2 hrs, Off 30 min
On, Off
On
On, Off
On

Printer Device

Serial, Internal Printer, Off

Language

English, French, German, Italian,


Spanish, Portuguese, Japanese

English

Line Frequency

50, 60 Hz

(By Destination)

Serial Format

TEXT, CSV, CUSP

CUSP

Baud Rate

2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400,


57600, Hi Speed

Hi Speed

ECG I, II, III, aVR, aVL, aVF, V;


Resp, Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2,
O2, Agent, Off

ECG I

Analog Out Select

Factory Default
DD-MM-YYYY
(Not Applicable)
(Not Applicable)

Internal Printer
(w/remote)
Serial (w/o remote)

Restore Factory Defaults Yes, No

No

Enter Service Mode

Yes, No (password protected)

No

Enter Simulation Mode

Yes, No (password protected)

No

Enter Network
Configuration

Yes, No (password protected)

No

NETWORK CONFIGURATION SETTINGS

Sync Type

Serial, Fiber Optic, Fiber-Wireless,


Wireless

Serial

IP Address

nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn

Set at factory

Netmask

nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn

Set at factory

Port

nnnnn

Set at factory

Connect Type

Peer-to-Peer, Access Point

Peer-to-Peer

Channel

1-14

10

SSID

16 characters

Set at factory

* Only on units with these parameters.

2 43

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

PRINTER SETTINGS

Setting

Selectable Options

Print Type (Demand)

Graphical, Tabular

Graphical

Alarm Print
BP Print

Off, Graphical, Tabular


Off, Graphical, Tabular

Off
Off

Interval Print

Off, 1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60 minutes


2, 4, 8,12, 24 hours
(1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30 seconds only
if Printer Device is set to Serial)
Graphical, Tabular
6,12,18, 24 seconds
6,12 seconds

Interval Print Type


Snapshot Size
History Size
Waveform 1

Gain (waveform 2)

ECG I, II, III, V, aVR, aVL, aVF,


PLETH, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Agent, N2O, Off
x0.5, x1.0, x2.0, x4.0
ECG I, II, III, V, aVR, aVL, aVF,
PLETH, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Agent, N2O, Off
x0.5, x1.0, x2.0, x4.0

Printer Speed

12.5, 25.0, 50.0 mm/sec

Gain (waveform 1)
Waveform 2

Factory Default

Off

Tabular
6 seconds
6 seconds

ECG II
x1.0

PLETH
x1.0
25.0 mm/sec

DISPLAY SETTINGS

Setting
Waveform 1:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:
Waveform 2:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:

Selectable Options

Factory Default

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF, and
Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
25 or 50 mm

ECG II
1x
25 mm per second
50 mm

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF,
Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Primary Halogenated Agent, N2O,
Breath by Breath, Cascade, and Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
25 or 50 mm

Off
1x
25 mm per second
25 mm

2 44

2 Monitor Setup

Setting

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Waveform 3:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:
Waveform 4:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:
Waveform 5:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:
Waveform 6:
Type:

Gain:
Sweep:
Size:

Selectable Options

Factory Default

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF,
Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Primary Halogenated Agent, N2O,
Breath by Breath, Cascade, and Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
25 mm

ECG I
1x
25 mm per second
25 mm

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF,
Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Primary Halogenated Agent, N2O,
Breath by Breath, and Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
12 or 25 mm

PLETH
1x
25 mm per second
12 mm

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF,
Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Primary Halogenated Agent, N2O,
Breath by Breath, Cascade, and Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
12 or 25 mm

aVL
1x
25 mm per second
12 mm

Lead I, Lead II, Lead III, Lead V,


Lead avL, Lead avR, Lead avF,
Pleth, IBP 1, IBP 2, EtCO2, O2,
Primary Halogenated Agent, N2O,
Breath by Breath, Cascade, and Off
0.5x, 1x, 2x, or 4x
6.25, 12.5, 25, or 50 mm per second
12 or 25 mm

aVR
1x
25 mm per second
12 mm

2 45

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3 Alarms and Messages


Alarm Description

The Veris monitor provides both audible and visible alarm indicators
to alert the operator of system status changes and physiological
parameter alarms.
Alarms are provided for all monitored parameters. Each parameter
limit alarm condition triggers both audible and visible alarms until one
of the following events occurs:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The parameter value returns to within the alarm limit.


The alarm limit is set beyond the present parameter value.
The SILENCE key is pressed. (Audible alarms only)
The monitor is placed in Standby Mode.
NOTE: The Alarm Limits menu only displays the parameters present
in the configuration.
Remote Display Alarms

The alarms that appear and sound on the patient monitor also appear
and sound on the optional remote display. The delay time for the
alarm from the patient monitor to the remote display is less than 1
second. Alarms can be silenced or turned off from the remote display
as if they were silenced or turned off at the patient monitor.

Audible Alarms

All alarms conform to EN 475 requirements. Informational messages


and system alerts do not have an audible alarm component.
HIGH PRIORITY ALARMS

The high priority alarm consists of a pair of audible bursts. Each burst
consists of 5 tone pulses. The pair of bursts repeat every eight
seconds. For each burst there is a short delay between the third and
fourth pulse. The frequency of each pulse is 1000 Hz.
MEDIUM PRIORITY ALARMS

Each medium priority alarm consists of an audible burst of three


pulses repeated approximately every 25 seconds. The frequency of
each pulse is 800 Hz.
LOW PRIORITY ALARMS

Each low priority alarm consists of an audible burst of two pulses


repeated approximately every 15 seconds. The frequency of each
pulse is 350 Hz.
ADVISORY ALERTS

Each advisory alert consists of an audible burst of two pulses


repeated approximately every 5 minutes. The frequency of each
pulse is 300 Hz.

3 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Visible Alarms

FLASHING NUMERICAL PARAMETERS

SpO2

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

98

In addition to audible alarms, visual text and symbol alarms are


displayed on the screen. Each message or symbol is specific to its
respective parameter or condition.

If a physiological parameter exceeds a high limit or falls below a low


limit value, the numerical value displayed flashes. This function
cannot be suspended and is visible when pop-up menus are
activated.
ALARM MESSAGE LINES

SPO2: SENSOR
V000 - NO ADMIT
- + - + Adult

There is space for two text lines provided directly below the NIBP box.
If multiple alarms are active, they alternate in the alarm area. The
bottom line is used for the informational messages and advisory
alerts.
Low level alarms and informational level messages are displayed in
this area for the vital signs that have a waveform displayed. For
parameters that do not have a waveforms displayed, all level of
alarms are reported in the Alarm Message Lines.
Informational, low, and medium level alarm text messages appear in
yellow and high alarm warning messages appear in red.

1mV
II

HIGH PULSE RATE

x1

WAVEFORM SLOT VISUAL ALARMS

When a high or medium alarm occurs for a vital sign that has an
active waveform, the message appears in the top center of the
waveform traces in large text. If there are multiple alerts to be
displayed in a waveform slot, the messages alternate.
If the waveform exists in multiple slots, either through cascade or
duplicate waveforms from alternate leads, the waveform messages
only occur in the top most slot.
Waveform Slot Alarms are not visible during the following conditions.
The waveform is not selected to be displayed.
A pop-up window or menu covers the waveform slot.
If a high or medium level alarm message cannot be displayed in the
waveform slot due to a pop-up window, the alarm message displays
in the Alarm Message Lines near the bottom of the screen.

Waveforms Frozen

If a waveform is frozen and data is still being acquired, high and


medium alarm messages appear based on the real-time data being
acquired, not the frozen waveform.

3 2

3 Alarms and Messages

Alert Icons

There are three alert icons that may appear on the main screen.
SUSPENDED ALARM ICONS

The alarm inhibit icon appears in the parameter boxes when an


individual parameters alarms are turned OFF.
When a red bell icon appears in the top waveform slot, all the
monitors audible alarms have been silenced. The duration of the
silence condition appears to the right of the bell icon.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2 Min = 2 minutes
= permanent
Visual alarms continue to be displayed as described.
BATTERY ICONS

Battery icons appear in the System Status Line indicating battery


status when AC (Mains) power is not available and battery charging
status when AC (Mains) is connected. The batteries change color
depending on their charge status. A battery icon with a cardiac
waveform also appears in the Heart Rate parameter box to indicate
the status of the ECG module battery. See Battery Indicators on
page 2-2 for more information about battery status and charging.
Special Alarm Conditions

Alarms at Start Up

Alarm Silence

The monitors alarms may be adjusted to suit the specific needs of


the clinical environment. Special functions are included for the benefit
of the user, so that nuisance alarms during patient setup do not
become distracting to the caregiver. Alarm Silence and Standby
Mode are available for this purpose. There are additional safeguards
included to protect against the misuse of these functions.
Audible alarms do not occur until the first valid measurement has
occurred for that parameter. Visual messages and alarms are present
immediately when a module is activated.
A SILENCE key is provided on the front panel of the monitor.
SILENCE 2 MINUTES

Pressing this key momentarily begins a two minute alarm silence.


The alarm icon appears in the System status Line followed by the
message 2 Min in white text.
New high, medium, and low level alarms end the two minute silence
when the alarm condition occurs.
Pressing the SILENCE key a second time ends the silence condition
and normal alarms resume.

3 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

PERMANENT SILENCE

CAUTION !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

All alarms are silenced, including those at higher levels, until the
permanent silence is ended.
Press and hold the SILENCE key to permanently silence the alarms.
The alarm icon appears in the System Status Line followed by an
infinity symbol. Notice that the long key-press tone occurs after
holding the key in for two seconds, confirming that permanent silence
was selected.
Pressing the SILENCE key a second time ends the silence condition
and normal alarms resume.
Alarms tone warning
(Warning Tone)

During a permanent alarm silence condition, and when this safeguard


is activated, an Alarms tone warning (Warning Tone) occurs when a
new high or medium level alarm is generated. The tone is a low
pitched double beep the same as the long key press tone.
A password is required to turn this function off. The Alarms tone
warning function can be set in the CONFIG menu.

Alarm Volume

The alarm volume can be set to levels 1 to 10 with 10 being the


loudest. This can be set in the ALARMS menu.
The alarm volume cannot be set to OFF. To permanently silence the
monitor press and hold the SILENCE key.
NOTE: This function does not change the volume of the audible heart
rate. The pulse tone volume is adjusted separately in the PARAMS
menu.
NOTE: The Alarm Limits menu only displays the parameters present
in the configuration.

Minimum Volume Auto-Reset

When the monitor is powered on, the last alarm volume setting
resumes, except when the previous volume setting was 1. In this case
the monitor returns with a volume setting of 2. This function cannot be
disabled.

3 4

3 Alarms and Messages

Standby Mode

This is a function on Base, Base Plus, and all Cardiology systems.


This function may be set in the CONFIG menu. It is not password
protected. All functions and alarms are suspended in Standby Mode.
The screen appears blank and the message STANDBY MODE
displays in large red characters.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

If the Standby Tone is set to ON, The monitor beeps once every
minute when in Standby Mode. There is a single low pitched beep to
alert the user that the monitor has been left in Standby Mode.
Agent Standby Mode

This is a function on all Anesthesiology systems. The AGENT STANDBY


MODE message appears in the top waveform slot in large red letters.
The symbol for permanent alarm silence also appears at the top of
the display.
The SILENCE key is not active during Agent Standby Mode. All
audible alarms are suspended until the STAND BY key is pressed.
The Agent Standby Mode is provided so that the Veris monitor can be
set up and checked with an anesthetic delivery system prior to clinical
use without generating distracting alarms.
Perform any preparatory procedures as required by your hospitals
protocols.
Press the STAND BY key to begin patient monitoring. The standby
message disappears and normal alarms resume. The SILENCE key
also returns to normal operation.

Standby Mode Timeout

This is a function on Base, Base Plus, and all Cardiology systems


and affects the Standby Mode. The Standby Mode Timeout can be
set in the CONFIG softkey menu. The monitor automatically returns
to monitoring within a specified amount of time. The range can be set
from 5 minutes to 2 hours, or OFF. A password is required to change
the setting for this safeguard.

SpO2 Low Limit Auto-Reset

If the SpO2 alarm limit level is set below 85%, the monitor
automatically returns to the value 90% each time the monitor is
turned on. If the CUSTOM DEFAULTS are set with an SpO2 low limit
value above 85%, the monitor automatically returns to the higher
value each time the monitor is turned on. This function cannot be
disabled.

SpO2 Low Limit Off Alarm

There is an alarm message generated if the SpO2 Low Limit is set to


OFF. The message LOW SAT OFF appears in yellow text in the Alarm
Message Lines. This alarm message continues to display regardless
of the SpO2 module being set to on or off in the PARAMS menu.
The monitor also displays the alarm alarm inhibit icon in the lower
right corner of the SpO2 numerical display box. The red alarm inhibit
icon is normally displayed when any SpO2 limit is turned off.

3 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Triggering an Alarm

A patient alarm is activated only when the value of one of the


patient's parameters exceeds one of the alarm limits. For example, if
the high saturation limit is set to 97%, the Veris monitor sounds an alarm
when the patients SpO2 reaches 98%. It will not alarm at 97%.
Similarly, if the low saturation limit is set to 90%, the alarm sounds
when the patient's SpO2 falls to 89% or below.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

WARNING !

To trigger an alarm, the patient's value must exceed the


parameter's limit.
Alarms Testing

To check and ensure that the audible and visual alarm limit settings
are operating as expected, the user may do so by performing the
following suggested procedure:
1. Apply power to the monitor. Observe that all displays and LEDs
illuminate.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

2. Place the SpO2 probe on your finger. Allow readings to stabilize.


3. Observe the pulse rate that is being displayed and adjust the
low pulse rate limit to a value greater than the observed pulse
rate value.
4. Verify that the low pulse rate violation message is displayed on
the LCD message bar and that the alarm tone sounds.
5. Once verified, return the low pulse rate or SpO2 waveform limit
to the previously set value, or to one that is required for the
patient to be monitored.

3 6

3 Alarms and Messages

Alarm Message List

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Shared Source Alarms

Alarms and messages for heart rate may be generated by more than
one parameter.
Priority

Description

LOW PULSE RATE

High

The heart rate value has dropped below the value set
in the ALARMS menu. This can be generated from
the ECG, IBP, SpO2, or the NIBP module.

HIGH PULSE RATE

High

The heart rate value has exceeded the value set in


the ALARMS menu. This can be generated from the
ECG, IBP, SpO2, or the NIBP module.

Priority

Description

High

The ECG amplitude is too low. Check electrodes,


lead wires, and cables. If necessary, change to a
different lead.

ECG Alarms
ECG:LOST

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Included here is a list of messages, alerts, and alarms that may


appear in the waveform slots or in the system message lines of the
display.

ECG:LA LEAD OFF


ECG: RA LEAD OFF
ECG: V LEAD OFF
ECG:LEADS OFF

User Selectable The left arm lead is off. Reconnect the lead.
User Selectable The right arm lead is off. Reconnect the lead.
User Selectable The chest lead is off. Reconnect the lead.
User Selectable The ECG leads are off. Either the left leg is off or

there is more than one lead off. Check the lead(s).


SpO2 Alarms
Priority

Description

SpO2: ERROR

Low

The monitor has detected a fault with the SpO2


function. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative.

SpO2:SENSOR

Low

The SpO2 sensor is not properly positioned.

SpO2:HIGH AMBIENT

Low

The SpO2 module is reading excessive light. Shield


the sensor or reduce the amount of ambient light.

SpO2:SEARCH

Low

The module cannot find a pulse in SpO2 signal.

SpO2:SIGNAL

Low

The SpO2 signal is too weak to measure. Check


sensor site for low perfusion and reposition sensor if
necessary.

Medium

The monitor is receiving no SpO2 signal. Check


sensor site for low perfusion and reposition sensor if
necessary.

Low

The SpO2 sensor or extension cable is missing or


defective. Connect or replace the sensor or the
extension cable.

SpO2:LOST

SpO2:NO SENSOR

3 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Priority

Description

LOW SpO2

High/Medium

The SpO2 value has dropped below the value set in


the ALARMS menu. This alarm can be set to high or
medium priority in the PARAMS menu.

HIGH SpO2

Medium

The SpO2 value has exceeded the value set in the


ALARMS menu.

Informational

The SpO2 low limit has been set to OFF in the


ALARMS menu.

Priority

Description

TEMP1: NO PROBE

Low

Probe is not present for temperature channel 1.

TEMP1:BAD PROBE

Low

Temperature probe for temperature channel 1 is


defective.

TEMP1: NOT READY

Low

Set-up period for temperature channel 1

TEMP1:ERROR

Low

The monitor has detected a fault with the temperature


module for temperature channel 1. Contact the
MEDRAD Service Department.

LOW TEMP1

Medium

Temperature value for temperature channel 1


dropped below the value set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH TEMP1

Medium

The temperature value for temperature channel 1 has


exceeded the value set in the ALARMS menu.

TEMP2: NO PROBE

Low

Probe is not present for temperature channel 2.

TEMP2:BAD PROBE

Low

Temperature probe for temperature channel 2 is


defective.

TEMP2: NOT READY

Low

Set-up period for temperature channel 2

TEMP2:ERROR

Low

The monitor has detected a fault with the temperature


module for temperature channel 2. Contact the
MEDRAD Service Department.

LOW TEMP2

Medium

Temperature value for temperature channel 2


dropped below the value set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH TEMP2

Medium

The temperature value for temperature channel 2 has


exceeded the value set in the ALARMS menu.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

LOW SAT OFF


Temperature Alarms

3 8

3 Alarms and Messages

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NIBP Alarms
Priority

Description

NIBP: HIGH SYS

Medium

The systolic value has exceeded the value set in the


ALARMS menu.

NIBP: LOW SYS

Medium

The systolic value has dropped below the value set in


the ALARMS menu.

NIBP: HIGH DIA

Medium

The diastolic value has exceeded the value set in the


ALARMS menu.

NIBP: LOW DIA

Medium

The diastolic value has dropped below the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH MAP

Medium

The mean arterial pressure value has exceeded the


value set in the ALARMS menu.

LOW MAP

Medium

The mean arterial pressure value has dropped below


the value set in the ALARMS menu.

BP: CALIB ERROR

Low

The monitor had detected a fault with the calibration.


Cycle the power to the monitor. If the problem
persists, contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative.

BP: CHECK CUFF

Low

Displayed when a neonatal/child cuff is used while


the monitor is in the adult or pediatric mode. Switch
to neonatal mode when using a neonatal cuff. Can
also indicate a leak in the cuff, or the cuff is wrapped
too loosely.

BP: LO PULSE AMP

Low

Pulse amplitude is too low. Reposition cuff.

BP: NO DEFLATE

Low

The monitor was unable to deflate the NIBP cuff.


Disconnect the cuff and contact MEDRAD Service or
your local representative.

BP: MAX TIME

Low

Maximum time (2 minutes) allowed for measuring the


blood pressure has been exceeded. Repeat
measurement.

BP: MAX PRESSURE

Low

Maximum allowed cuff pressure (300 mmHg adult or


150 mmHg neonatal) has been attained.

BP: ERROR

Low

The monitor has detected a fault with the NIBP


function. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative.

BP: NOT TAKEN

Low

The monitor was unable to take a blood pressure


reading. Check cuff position.

Informational

The cuff has not completely deflated. Wait for


deflation and then press NIBP key again.

BP: PLEASE WAIT

3 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

IBP Alarms
Priority

Description

High

The heart rate value has dropped below the


detectable limit for the channel. Verify that the correct
site has been selected for the channel. This message
is only generated for channels set to ART or PA sites.

HIGH SYS

Medium

The systolic value has exceeded the value set in the


ALARMS menu.

LOW SYS

Medium

The systolic value has dropped below the value set in


the ALARMS menu.

HIGH DIA

Medium

The diastolic value has exceeded the value set in the


ALARMS menu.

LOW DIA

Medium

The diastolic value has dropped below the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH MAP

Medium

The mean arterial pressure value has exceeded the


value set in the ALARMS menu.

LOW MAP

Medium

The mean arterial pressure value has dropped below


the value set in the ALARMS menu.

OFF SCALE

Informational

The IBP value has exceeded the scale for the


channel, and the waveform has been clipped. Adjust
the range to display the entire waveform.

NO XDUCER

Informational

Transducer is not connected to the channel. Check


cable connections and verify that the correct
transducer is being used.

BAD XDUCER

Informational

An incorrect or damaged transducer is connected to


the channel. Specified transducers must have an
impedance greater than 300 ohms.

Medium

There is an error in the factory calibration memory.


IBP monitoring is suspended until corrected. Contact
MEDRAD Service or your local representative.

ZERO GOOD

Informational

The IBP zero calibration for the channel was


successful. The zero pressure point has been
adjusted to the current ambient room pressure.

ZERO FAIL

Informational

The zero calibration was unsuccessful. Calibration


was aborted due to detection of beat or pressure
fluctuations. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative if the monitor continues to fail
calibration.

NOT ZEROED

Informational

The transducer needs to be zeroed. Calibrate the


monitor with the transducer.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

HR LOST

FACT CAL

NOTE: IBP alarms are preceded by the specific site and channel
number such as ART1:NO XDUCER.

3 10

3 Alarms and Messages

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Capnometry (CO2)
Alarms and Messages
Priority

Description

LOW EtCO2

Medium

The end-tidal CO2 value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH EtCO2

Medium

The end-tidal CO2 value has exceeded the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

LOW INCO2

Medium

The inspired CO2 value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH INCO2

Medium

The inspired CO2 value has exceeded the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

LOW RESP

Medium

The respiration value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu. This is generated from the
capnography module.

HIGH RESP

Medium

The respiration value has exceeded the value set in


the ALARMS menu. This is generated from the
capnography module.

Priority

Description

AGT:NO BREATH

High

No breath detected. Check patient for apnea. Check


sampling device and adjust placement if necessary.
May indicate a leak in the breathing circuit.

WRONG AGENT

High

The primary agent that the operator has selected


does not match the highest concentration agent
detected by the analyzer. Check the primary agent
setting and the agent delivery system immediately.
This alarm is not active when automatic primary
agent detection is selected.

AGT:OCCLUSION

Medium

The sampling line or water trap to the Veris monitor is


completely blocked. The Veris monitor attempts to
clear the block by drawing the occlusion into the
water trap. Replace sampling line as necessary.

REPLACE TRAP

Medium

The Veris monitor trap needs to be replaced.

MIXED AGENT

Medium

More than one halogenated agent is present.

LOW INS AGENT

Medium

The inspired agent value has dropped below the


value set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH INS AGENT

Medium

The inspired agent value has exceeded the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

LOW EXP AGENT

Medium

The expired agent value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH EXP AGENT

Medium

The expired agent value has exceeded the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

LOW INS N2O

Medium

The inspired N2O value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

Agent Gas
Alarms and Messages

3 11

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Priority

Description

HIGH INS N2O

Medium

The inspired N2O value has exceeded the value set


in the ALARMS menu.

LOW EXP N2O

Medium

The expired N2O value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH EXP N2O

Medium

The expired N2O value has exceeded the value set in


the ALARMS menu.

AGT:INSERT TRAP

Medium

The water trap on the Veris monitor is not inserted.


Trap is partially blocked, wrong type of trap, or
defective. Replace trap.

AGT: AUTO CAL

Quiet Medium The agent bench is doing an auto calibration.

AGT: BENCH FAIL

Low

A hardware failure has been detected. Contact


MEDRAD Service or your local representative.

AGT: NO EXHAUST

Low

Scavenging line on the Veris monitor is blocked or the


scavenging system is defective. Remove blockage or
correct gas scavenging system.

AGT:IR FAIL

Low

A hardware failure has been detected. Contact


MEDRAD Service or your local representative.

AGT:PNEUMATICS

Low

A hardware failure has been detected. Contact


MEDRAD Service or your local representative.

O2:SENSOR

Low

The O2 cell inside the monitor is expended and must


be replaced. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative.

AGT: BAD CAL

Low

The Veris monitor was unable to calibrate agent gas


detector. Contact MEDRAD Service or your local
representative.

AGT: WARMING

Informational

The Veris monitor has not attained full accuracy for


agent concentrations.

AGT: DISCONNECT

Informational

There is an agent bench hardware error.

AGT:MANUAL MODE

Informational

The monitor is set to manual identification of a


selected primary agent. The WRONG AGENT
warning appears if the selected agent does not
match the detected primary agent.

AGT:AUTOMATIC

Informational

The monitor is set to automatic identification of the


current primary agent.

3 12

3 Alarms and Messages

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Oxygen Monitoring
(O2) Alarms
Priority

Description

LOW EtO2

Medium

The expired O2 value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH EtO2

Medium

The expired O2 value has exceeded the value set in


the ALARMS menu.

LOW INO2

Medium

The inspired O2 value has dropped below the value


set in the ALARMS menu.

HIGH INO2

Medium

The inspired O2 value has exceeded the value set in


the ALARMS menu.

3 13

MEDRAD Veris 8600

System Alerts
Priority

Description

Advisory

Battery power is low. Recharge batteries.

NO ADMIT

Informational

The patient has not been admitted in the ADM/DIS


menu.

WAVEFORM FROZEN

Informational

The user has selected the waveforms to be frozen.


Press the FREEZE key again to resume normal
display.

ECG OFF

Informational

The ECG module has been turned off.

PRINT: PAPER OUT

Informational

The printer on the remote display has detected the


end of the paper roll.

PRINT: HEAD UP

Informational

Paper is loaded and manual lever is up on the remote


display. Move the lever to the down position. Check
for paper jam.

PRINT: Vp ERROR

Informational

Internal printer communication problem on the


remote display. Contact MEDRAD Service.

PRINT: TEMP ERR

Informational

The thermal printing element on the remote display is


not at the correct temperature. Contact MEDRAD
Service or your local representative.

Vxxx - NO ADMIT

Informational

The patient has not been admitted and wireless


communication is not setup. The numbers following
the Vxxx indicate the units wireless network
indentifier.

CONM H/W ERROR

Low

Indicates that the NIBP board is not communicating.

VSM H/W ERROR

Low

Indicates that the Vital Signs Module (VSM) board is


not communicating.

IBP H/W ERROR

Low

Indicates that the IBP board is not communicating.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

LOW BATTERY

3 14

4 Trends
Description

The trend memory stores patient data at regular intervals for review
at a later time. Trend data can be reviewed by printing it out on the
remote displays built-in printer, through the serial port, or on the
screen. Trend data is date and time stamped.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

To view the tabular trend, press the TREND key and the table
appears in the lower channels of the waveform display.
Trend Interval

The trend interval can be changed by pressing and holding the


TREND key while viewing the tabular trend. A second window
appears which allows you to change the trend interval by rotating the
control knob.
Trend data for each parameter is stored as follows:
SpO2 value is stored every 30 seconds at the zero and 30
seconds mark.
The precedent heart rate is stored every 30 seconds at the zero
and 30 second marks. This data is recorded from secondary
sources if the primary sources are unavailable.
Respiration value is stored every 30 seconds at the zero and 30
seconds mark.
NIBP storage is determined by cycle time interval, demand and
stat readings. Every NIBP reading is stored in the trend
memory.
Continuous temperature readings are stored every 30 seconds
at the zero and 30 seconds mark.
Inspired and expired CO2 and O2 data is stored every 30
seconds at the zero and 30 seconds mark.
IBP data is stored every 30 seconds at the zero and 30 seconds
mark.
Agent and N2O data is stored every 30 seconds at the zero and
30 seconds mark.

Capacity

The trend memory can store up to 24 hours of trend data at 30


second intervals, with a maximum of 480 NIBP readings and/or
tabular trend markers in a 24 hour interval.
When the trend memory is filled to maximum capacity, the new trend
data begins to overwrite the oldest trend data in the memory.

Trend Screen Update

The table is not updated while it is being viewed. Scroll up to view


data that is recorded after the trend screen is activated. The trend
screen automatically returns to the main screen after 45 seconds.

4 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Trend Setup

Up to two parameters may be viewed in graphical format in the trend


window. Change the trend view in the Trend Setup window.
To view trends:
1. Press the TREND key to enter the trend window.
2. Either the Tabular or Graphics Trend appears.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3. Press and hold the TREND key to enter the Trend Setup
window.
4. Set the trend type to Graphical or Tabular.
5. Press the TREND key. The trend displays.
6. Rotate the knob clockwise to see older data.
7. Press and hold the TREND key to exit trends.
Selecting EXIT returns to the main screen. Press the TREND key
again to return to the trend display after changing the settings.
NOTE: The trend setting window defaults to Tabular Trend. The
Settings for Trend Interval, First Trend Parameter and Second Trend
Parameter are not visible until the Trend Type is set to Graphical.

4 2

4 Trends

If Graphical is selected, set the Trend Interval and Trend Parameters


as desired.
EXIT

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Trend Type
Trend Interval
First Trend Parameter
Second Trend Parameter
Trend Screen
Use Parameter Color
Clear Trend

Graphical
4 Hours
HR
Color
SPO2
Color
Normal
NO
NO

Figure 4-1: Graphical Trend Setup Window


If Tabular is selected, the Trend Screen is set to Basic Trend Display
for Base and Cardiology models. On Anesthesia models select Basic
Trend Display or Advanced Trend Display. Select YES or NO for Use
parameter colors.
EXIT
Trend Type
Trend Interval
Trend Screen
Use Parameter Colors

Tabular
4 Hours
Basic Trend Display
YES

Clear Trend

NO

Figure 4-2: Tabular Trend Setup Window

4 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Graphical Trends

The graphical trend window covers the lower five waveform slots. The
physiological parameter and the unit of measurement is listed
vertically on the left side for the first displayed line graph. The second
line graph is labeled vertically on the right side.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The graphical trend window displays for about 45 seconds before


timing out. The trend window does not update automatically. The
trend window updates each time it is accessed.
The most current data is always displayed on the right side. Time
stamps for the selected Trend Interval are indicated below the line
graphs.
Scrolling the Graph

The trend window can be set to display up to 24 hours of data.


Rotating the knob clockwise scrolls the graph to show older data.
Rotating the knob counter-clockwise scrolls back towards the most
current data.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The rate of advance varies with the selected Trend Interval.


Trend Interval
2 hours
4 hours
8 hours
12 hours
24 hours

Minutes per each click


1
2
4
6
12

The time stamps are updated each time the knob is rotated. It is not
possible to scroll past the current time.
The trend graph resets to the current time stamp upon exiting to the
main screen and returning to the trend window. The trend graph
remains at the selected time location while entering and returning
from the trend settings window.
Interruption Due to
Power Cycling or Standby Mode

The graphical trend has gaps due to power cycling of the monitor. If
the period of missing data is within the last 24 hour period the gaps
appear where the power was turned off. The graphical trend also has
gaps when the monitor is placed in Standby Mode. These gaps are
defined with gray backgrounds.
If the power was turned off or the Standby Mode existed for a period
of more than a day, a blank period is inserted between the new and
old data. The new data begins on a new window with new time
stamps. The gap between the monitoring sessions is equal to the
Trend Interval in length.

4 4

4 Trends

Graphical Trend Display

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1mV
II

Two physiological parameters may be displayed at the same time in


the graphical trend window. For IBP and NIBP the pressure values for
diastolic, systolic and mean will be represented. The line graphs are
shown in the color selected by the user for trend displays.
BPM

300

4:00 PM

HR

IBP1

10:00 PM
150

RESP Br/m

98
IBP1

4:00 AM145

20
CO2
mmHg

ART

145/105

(125)

mmHg IBP2

CVP

mmHg

(13)

-10 CO2 mmHg

10:12 JUN-18-04

27

22:12
AGE

JUN-18-04 10:12 EXP


24;18 min
mmHg
INS
GAS O2
C
T2
MAP %
CYCLE OFF
EXP 17
ALARMS PARAMS DISPLAY ZERO IP1
Art1:NO XDUCER INS 21
ADM/DIS CONFIG
PRINT ZERO IP2 - + - +
Adult
John
Smith
T1

-+

60
SpO2
300 SpO2

BPM

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

HR

ECG:LEADS OFF

37.1
37.1

C NIBP

147/89

(107)

150 ml/min

8
HAL

N2O

11.0 39
10.5 64
14:12:59

Figure 4-3: Graphical Trend Screen


The sample graphical trend screen above shows HR and arterial IBP
data from IBP channel one (IBP1). The IBP data is displayed as a set
of thinner black lines for systolic, MAP, and diastolic values
respectively. (On the monitor screen the IBP data is represented in
the color selected by the user.) The lowest of the four lines is the HR
information. The color of the heart rate line is user-selectable in the
Trend Setup menu.
NOTE: The color of the heart rate waveform remains the color the
user set it as. The illustration above shows changes merely to
highlight the waveform as it changes its source.
10:12 a.m.
4:00 p.m.

Monitoring began.
IBP event is recorded.

10:00 p.m.

ECG leads removed. (HR defaults to IBP)

4:00 a.m.

IBP lines removed. (HR defaults to SpO2)

10:12 a.m.

Current HR from SpO2 source.

4 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Tabular Trends

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Tabular Trend Markers

Various messages appear in the tabular trend to indicate that system


events have occurred. A complete list is as follows:
STNDBY ON
AGT STNDBY ON
AUDIO ON
FREEZE ON
SIM ON
NEW PATIEN

STNDBY OFF
AGT STNDBY OFF
AUDIO OFF
FREEZE OFF
POWER

NOTE: Permanent silence and two minute silence are both recorded
as an AUDIO ON/OFF event in the tabular trend table.
Trend Messages

The trend also records messages in the trend table that indicate the
status of the monitor at that time. The time and date stamp is also
recorded when a marker is recorded. All messages appear in the
trend table regardless of the interval selected for the table or the time
that the message occurred. Markers are recorded for:
Standby Mode is entered or exited (STNDBY ON/STNDBY
OFF);
Agent Standby Mode is entered or exited (AGT STNDBY ON/AGT
STNDBY OFF);
Silence Mode (both two minute and permanent) is entered or
exited (AUDIO ON/AUDIO OFF);
Waveforms are frozen or unfrozen (FREEZE ON/FREEZE
OFF);
Power is turned on or off (POWER); or
A new patient is admitted or discharged via the ADM/DIS
window (NEW PATIEN).
NOTE: If the patient size is changed while admitting a new
patient all the previous trend data is cleared.
At midnight the monitor records the date change into the trend table.
This does not occur if the monitor was turned off at midnight.

4 6

4 Trends

Data Format

The parameters are listed in the first column followed by the units.
Time stamps at the half minute mark are displayed with a plus
+ sign.
Measured parameters that exceed or drop below alarm limits
are highlighted.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

When a sampling module is on and no value can be determined


for the parameter, three dashes --- are displayed in the trend
table.
If a sampling module is turned off in the PARAMS window, the
word OFF displays in the trend.
If a sampling module is turned on and no valid measurement
has been taken, the word ERR displays in the trend if the
parameter has an error condition.
If there is no NIBP data for a particular time stamp, the NIBP
trend area is left blank.
NOTE: The Trends are automatically cleared when the DATE/TIME is
changed.
_______________________________________________________
18-JUN-04
RATE
BPM
SpO2
%
NIBP SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg
TEMP 1
F
TEMP 2
F
RESP
Br/m
IBP1 SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg
IBP2 SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg

11:45+ 11:45 11:44+ 11:44 11:43+ 11:43


60E
60E
60E
60E
99
99
99
98
NEW POWER
PATIEN

98.6
98.6
20C
145
105
125AR

98.6
98.6
20C
144
105
124AR

98.6
ERR
20C
144
105
124AR

98.6
ERR
20C
146
105
126AR

13CV

13CV

13CV

13CV

_______________________________________________________

Figure 4-4: Sample Trend Table (Base and Cardiology)


For the trend table shown the interval is set to 30 seconds.

4 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Anesthesia units display two trend screens. The default is Basic


Trend Display. Select Advanced Trend Display for Trend Screen in
the Trend Setup Window to view the second tabular trend screen.
The Basic Trend Display screen displays:
Heart rate
SpO2
NIBP (Systolic, Diastolic, and MAP)
Temp 1 and 2
Respiration
CO2 (Inspired and Expired)
O2 (Inspired and Expired)
Agent (Inspired and Expired)
N2O (Inspired and Expired)
_______________________________________________________
18-JUN-04
RATE
BPM
SpO2
%
NIBP SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg
TEMP 1
F
TEMP 2
F
RESP
Br/m
CO2
INS mmHg
EXP
O2
INS %
EXP
AGT
INS %
EXP
N2O
INS %
EXP

11:45+ 11:45 11:44+ 11:44 11:43+ 11:43


60E
60E
60E
60E
99
99
99
98
NEW POWER
PATIEN

98.6
98.6
20C
8
27
21
17
10.5H
11.0
64
39

98.6
98.6
20C
8
27
21
17
10.5H
11.0
63
39

98.6
ERR
20C
8
27
21
17
10.5H
11.0
64
39

98.6
ERR
20C
8
27
21
17
10.5H
11.0
64
39

_______________________________________________________

Figure 4-5: Sample Basic Trend Display Table


The Advanced Trend Display screen displays:
IBP1 (Systolic, Diastolic, and MAP)
IBP2 (Systolic, Diastolic, and MAP)
_______________________________________________________
18-JUN-04
IBP1 SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg
IBP2 SYS mmHg
DIA mmHg
MAP mmHg

11:45+ 11:45 11:44+ 11:44 11:43+ 11:43


145
144
144
146
105
105
105
105
125AR 124AR 124AR 126AR

13CV

13CV

13CV

13CV

_______________________________________________________

Figure 4-6: Sample Advanced Trend Display Table


NOTE: The Advanced Trend Display screen only displays IBP
information. To view trend data of the other parameters, you must
reset Trend Screen in the Trend Setup Window to Basic Trend
Display.

4 8

4 Trends

HEART RATE SOURCE INDICATION

The source of the heart rate data is indicated by a letter following


each heart rate value.
E = electrocardiogram,
I = invasive blood pressure,
S = pulse oximetry and

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

N = Non-invasive blood pressure.


IBP SITE INDICATION

The IBP site is indicated by a letter following each mean value.


AR = Arterial (ART)
PA = Pulmonary Artery (PA)
CV = Central Venous (CVP)
RA = Right Atrial (RA)
LA = Left Atrial (LA)

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

IP = Intracranial (ICP)
RV = Right Ventricle (RV)
LV = Left Ventricle (LV)
RESPIRATION SOURCE INDICATION

The source of the respiration data is indicated by a letter following


each respiration value.
C = capnometer (CO2 module).
AGENT SOURCE INDICATION

The agent source is indicated by a letter following the inspired value


for the agent.
H = Halothane
E = Enflourane
I = Isoflourane
D = Desflurane
S = Sevoflurane
U = Unknown

4 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Clearing the Memory

To clear the trend memory:


1. Press the TREND key to display the trend.
2. Press and hold TREND key again to display the trend setup
window.
3. Select the clear trend option and select YES to confirm the
clearing of the trend data.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The trend memory is automatically cleared when:


The time and/or date are changed in the menu
The patient size is changed (adult/pediatric/neonate).

4 10

5 ECG
Theory of Operation
Heart Rate

The heart rate is determined primarily from the ECG waveform data.
The monitor has a user selectable smart heart rate function. It
automatically uses alternate sources to determine heart rate, if the
primary source becomes unavailable.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The IBP pulse rate is used if the ECG waveform data is


unavailable.
The SpO2 pulse rate is used if the ECG and the IBP waveforms
are not available.
The NIBP pulse rate is used if the ECG, the SpO2, and the IBP
waveforms are not available.
Response times for ECG heart rate meter change from 80 BPM to 40
BPM and from 80 BPM to 120 BPM is less than or equal to 10
seconds.
NOTE: The accuracy and range of the heart rate depends upon the
source. See Specifications in Appendix C.
NOTE: The NIBP-based heart rate is not a continuous measurement
and is only current during an NIBP measurement.
ECG Measurement

The electrocardiogram (ECG or EKG) records the changing potential


generated by electrical activity of the heart.
Electrical currents influenced by the cardiac impulse flow through the
body tissue around the heart.
METHOD

To obtain an overall view of the heart's electrical activity, three or five


electrodes attached to a leadset detect electrical impulses from the
patient's heart to the skin. The monitor calculates the difference in
electrical force between two electrode sites. Electrode polarity
(positive, negative, or ground) depends on the cable receptacle the
lead cable is attached to and the lead selected on the monitor screen.
The ECG circuitry amplifies, filters, and digitizes (converts analog
signals to digital signals) the received electrical potentials. The ECG
module converts these electrical signals into light pulses which the
monitor receives and converts back into a recognizable signal.
The ECG design provides for standard 3-lead, or on some systems
5-lead, monitoring. The 3-lead ECG provides conventional bipolar
limb leads (I, II, III). The 5-lead ECG provides additional aVR, aVL,
aVF, and V views.

5 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The monitor has automatic lead switching capability for 5-lead


monitoring, which may be selected by the user. If a lead becomes
detached or is unmeasurable, the monitor can automatically display
an alternate lead view using the remaining leads.
STABILITY OF ACCURACY

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The accuracy of the monitor is not affected by arrhythmia or other


physiological conditions where the electrocardiogram amplitude and
heart rate are within the detectable limits specified for the monitor.
The monitor has signal filtering in the 60 Hz and 50 Hz bands that
reduce electrical interference from the AC (mains) power sources.
The accuracy of the ECG is affected by the static and gradient
magnetic fields. Determine only rate and rhythm with the patient in
the presence of a static and gradient magnetic field.
If a defibrilator is used on a patient, the ECG traces disappear. The
traces resume within 10 seconds after defibrilation is complete.
ECG Module

The ECG module uses a Fiber Optic Transmit/Receive technology. The


ECG module is a battery-powered, fiber optic interface from the patient
to the monitor.

Gating Signals

The input gating signal is derived from any one of two sourcesECG
or Plethysmogram (SpO2) waveform and is available in 2
user-selectable forms, pulse or waveform. An icon of the gating signal
source and a visual indication appears at the upper left corner of the
heart rate numerical display box.
ECG GATING

The ECG gating interface takes the ECG signal from the ECG
module. The Veris monitor then produces a signal out, which can be
used by the MR scanner electronics to cardiac gate an MR scan. The
fiber optic connection between the ECG module and the Veris monitor
provides complete isolation of the patient from the gating interface
and the MR scanner.
ECG Waveform Size

A minimum of four and a half seconds worth of data at a sweep speed


of 25mm per second is displayed. Waveforms can have an amplitude
of 5, 10, 20, or 40 mm/mV. Waveforms can have sweep speeds of 50,
25, 12.5 or 6.25 mm per second. At an amplitude of 10mm/mV and a
sweep speed of 25 per second, the aspect ratio is 0.4. The aspect
ratio is not tested for compliance per EC 13 section 5.2.9.7(b).

5 2

5 ECG

ECG Monitoring
(Electrocardiogram)

The following instructions describe procedures for preparing a patient


for ECG monitoring.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Shown below is the patient monitor with a fiber optic cable, ECG
module, and a 3-lead leadset (left) and a 5-lead leadset (right)
attached.

Figure 5-1: ECG Cable Connection with the ECG Module

WARNING !

Use only recommended leadsets. The use of leadsets not


recommended could result in injury, such as patient burns. Use
only the leadset that is included with your Veris monitor.
Use only recommended electrodes. The use of other electrodes
could result in injury, such as patient burns. Use only ConMed
Invisatrace electrodes or other electrodes specifically
recommended by Medrad for use with the Veris monitor.
The ECG signal is not intended for diagnostic use. Interference
due to static and gradient magnetic fields can occur. Determine
only rate and rhythm during ECG use.
This device is not intended for intracardiac ECG applications.
Use the ECG monitor and accessories only as directed.
Do not place defibrillator paddles on or next to ECG patient
electrodes. Contact between defibrillator paddles and ECG
electrodes could injure the patient.
The conductive parts of the ECG electrodes should not come in
contact with other conductive parts, including earth ground.
Such contact could result in patient injury, death, or equipment
damage.

5 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

WARNING !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

There is no defibrillator synchronization output on the Veris


monitor. Make no connections between the Veris system and a
defibrillator.
PACEMAKER PATIENTS: This device does not include
pacemaker spike rejection capability. Heart rate readouts
derived from the ECG patient connections are likely to display
erroneous high or erratic rates when a pacemaker is in use.
Keep pacemaker patients under close surveillance. For
pacemaker patients it may be advisable to select the SpO2
function as the primary heart rate source.
The heart rate calculated by the ECG function may be affected
by cardiac arrhythmia.
Leakage currents may increase if other equipment is
interconnected to the patient. The increased leakage currents
may present a hazard to the patient.
!

CAUTION !

ECG electrodes can cause skin irritation. Change the electrodes


and reposition every 24 hours or sooner if there is sign of
inflammation.
Place the ECG module out of the imaging volume. Make certain
that the module is stationary (i.e., not moving or vibrating).
Do not bend fiber optic cables too tightly. The ECG module fiber
optic cable should have a minimum bend radius of 4 cm
(1.6 inches).
All metallic wires going into the magnet bore will drain off RF
power; the fiber optic cables are non-conductive and will not
drain off power or heat up. For RF exposures up to specific
absorption rates (SAR) of 2.0 W/kg, the ECG leads will not
cause patient burns when they are properly insulated and free
of loops. Monitoring of ECG at very high RF exposures, above
2.0 W/kg, is not recommended for the general patient
population. Such monitoring should be attempted on conscious
patients with good temperature reflex so they may warn the
operator of excessive heat at monitoring sites.
All cables should be watched carefully during patient loading
and unloading to avoid entanglement with the patient table
mechanisms. Cables and the ECG module should not be
permitted to swing or move during scanning to avoid baseline
wander.

5 4

5 ECG

CAUTION !

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The "T" wave may become excessively large or inverted with the
patient in the magnetic field. This effect is due to
electromagnetic flow induced voltage and may interfere with
QRS detection. Try other leads and/or electrode placements for
best results.
Protection

The ECG module protection against electric shock is of Type CF with


protection against the effects of defibrillation.

ECG Performance

For heart rate display, the Veris monitor properly counts normal
rhythms with T-wave height to 80% of the QRS height at a heart rate
of 80 BPM.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

WARNING !

The presence of tall T-waves greater than 80% of the R-wave


may result in a double counting of beats.
For heart rate averaging, the Veris monitor uses a 32 beat average
except when there is a rapid change in heart rate, in which case the
Veris monitor switches to a four beat average.
The Veris 8600 monitor complies to AAMI EC13-2002 with
exceptions. The monitor does not reject beats of 10ms or less in
duration and 1mV or less in amplitude per EC13 section 5.2.6.
The monitor employs a one Hertz filter that allows extraction of ECG
waveforms in an MRI environment. Although this design deviates
from requirements of EC13 per sections 5.2.9.7 and 5.2.9.8, there is
a minimal affect to the aspect ratio, impulse response and the ST
component of the ECG waveform.
The Veris monitor does not provide pacemaker pulse detection and
pacer indication per EC13 section 5.2.9.12 and electrosurgical unit
(ESU) suppression is not provided per section 5.2.9.14. Since the
monitor is intended for indoor use, the functional ECG temperature
range is specified as 15 C to 35 C.
Sudden Changes In Heart Rate

A step change in heart rate from 80 to 40 BPM or from 80 to 120 BPM


will be displayed on the 8100 heart rate display in ten seconds or less
(tested per AAMI EC-13 Clause 4.1.2.1 (f): 105 BPM ascending rate
target, 54 BPM descending rate target).
Time to alarm when the ECG input changes from an 80 BPM normal
sinus rhythm to a 180 BPM ventricular tachycardia (Hi Alarm = 100
BPM) is less than five seconds.

5 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The waveform specified in AAMI EC-13, Figure 3a (80 BPM


ventricular bigeminy), when applied to the 8100, displays as 80 BPM.
Waveforms b, c, & d from Figure 3 (in EC-13) have not been applied
to this product.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Electrode Selection

MEDRAD recommends using ConMed Invisatrace electrodes. These


electrodes are MRI safe.
See Accessories in Appendix D for a complete list of recommended
electrodes and accessories.

5 6

5 ECG

ECG Module Interface

The ECG module is a battery-powered, fiber optic interface from the


patient to the monitor. The module has five color-coded connectors
along its front surface to interface with the ECG leadsets and 2 colorcoded fiber-optic connectors on the rear surface to interface with the
Veris monitor.
NOTE: The ECG module protection against electric shock is of type
CF, with protection against the effects of defibrillation.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: Always keep the ECG module on the charger when not in use,
or when anticipating a period of prolonged inactivity.
The ECG module contains an internal, rechargeable battery. A power
switch is provided on the rear of the module. When the monitor is not
in use, make certain that the power switch on the ECG module is off
to extend battery life. The battery is not user-serviceable and cannot
be replaced.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

ECG Module Ports And Switches

The following graphic and table details the ports and switches on the
ECG module.

3
4

Figure 5-2: ECG Module Ports, Switches


Item

Name

Description

Patient Connectors

Color-coded connections for ECG leadset.

Battery charger
connection

Port for plugging the ECG module to the


charger.

Power Switch

This is the power on/off switch.

Connection to
monitor

Fiber optic input/output connections to send


ECG signal to the monitor.

5 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

WARNING !

Do not charge the ECG module battery while the ECG module
is connected to the patient! Charging the ECG module battery
during patient use can lead to electric shock through the
leadset.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not take the ECG module charger into the magnet room! The
ECG module charger contains ferromagnetic material and may
be attracted to the magnet, resulting in patient or operator injury.
The ECG module contains non-servicable batteries. Improper
disposal of batteries may result in explosion, leakage, or
personal injury. Do not open the batteries. Do not dispose of the
batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations concerning the
disposal of spent Lithium-Ion batteries or contact Medrad for
assistance.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

CAUTION !

Only use the Veris ECG module charger to charge the module.
Use of other chargers may damage the module and/or charger.
Do not use the charger on other devices as this may damage
the charger and/or device.
NOTES:
When not in use, turn off the ECG module to extend battery life.
Charge the ECG module at least once per week.
Keep the charger cover on the ECG module closed, except when the
module is being charged. This protects the connector from moisture
or foreign objects.
Battery Condition

When the module is connected and switched on, the ECG module
battery icon on the monitor display indicates the status of the battery.
GREEN:
YELLOW:

BLACK:

The battery is good; greater than 7 hours of


continuous use remaining
The battery is low; less than 7 hours of continuous
use remaining. Charge the module as soon as
possible.
The battery is dead or no communication. Check the
power switch and the fiber optic cable. Recharge the
battery prior to use.

5 8

5 ECG

Charging the
Battery

Charge the ECG module at least once per week using the provided
charger. Charge the module only when it is not in use and not
connected to a patient.
1. Plug the charger into an AC outlet, outside the magnet room.
2. Ensure the ECG module is disconnected from the patient and
that the module power switch is in the OFF position.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3. Open the charger cover on the ECG module.

Charger
Connector

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Charger
Cover

Figure 5-3: Charger Connector Detail


4. Align the arrow on the charger cable with the arrow on the ECG
module and insert the cable firmly into the module.

Arrows

Figure 5-4: Align the Arrows

5 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

5. Confirm that the module is charging by observing the indicator


on the charger and using the instructions printed on the charger.
NOTE:
When the module is in rapid charge the green charger indicator
is flashing 50% on and 50% off.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

When a charge is pending the green charger indicator is on 10%


of time and off 90% of time.
When the module has a "charge failure" the green charger
indicator continuously blips without switching to flash.

Charger
Indicator

Figure 5-5: Charging with Indicator Light


6. The ECG module charges in 3 hours or less. Observe the
charger indicator to determine when the module is fully charged.
7. Remove the charger cable from the module and close the
charger connector cover.

5 10

5 ECG

ECG Monitoring
Patient Preparation

Proper patient preparation and placement of the electrodes is the


single most important factor in obtaining a good ECG signal.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1. Have a thorough understanding of the patients history. This may


assist in determining where electrodes are placed.
2. Prepare the patient by ensuring that hair is removed from the
locations where you intend to place the electrodes. Use
Nu-Prep gel with cotton gauze or a washcloth. A small amount
of Nu-Prep gel should be applied to the cotton gauze or wash
cloth. The area where the electrode is to be placed should then
be thoroughly cleaned by rubbing it in a circular motion.
3. ConMed Invisitrace electrodes are recommended for use with
the Veris monitor. They should be placed on the prepared
locations ensuring that they securely adhere to the skin surface.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

NOTES:
Do not use alcohol. Alcohol removes electrolytes from the skin
and decreases the quality of the electrical contact.
Medrad recommends the use of ConMed Invisitrace electrodes.
These electrodes are MRI compatible. See Accessories in
Appendix D for a complete list of recommended electrodes and
accessories.
Use three (or five) new, MR-compatable electrodes.
!

WARNING !

Connect only MEDRAD approved 3-lead or 5-lead ECG cables


from the patient to the ECG module. Do not connect any other
signal source to the ECG module.
When positioning the patient in the MR scanner, locate the
electrodes less than four inches from each other and do not loop
the leadset. Insulate the leadset from the patient. It is not
dangerous for loops to form in the fiber optic cable.
!

CAUTION !

Use only accessories designated for use with this monitor. Use
of accessories not designated for use with the Veris monitor can
cause inaccurate measurements and/or a safety hazard for the
patient.
Do not allow the conductive parts of the patient electrodes to
contact other conductive parts, including ground (earth).

5 11

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CAUTION !

Static magnetic fields can cause reversible electrocardiogram


changes. Determine only rate and rhythm with the patient in the
presence of a static magnetic field.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

High Frequency (HF) surgical equipment may affect the


operation of the ECG unit. The system is not designed to
operate in the presence of ESU interference.
Lead Placement

The monitor provides ECG options for 3- and 5-lead patient setups.
The following instructions describe both the 3- and 5-lead
configurations. It is important to use the MEDRAD recommended
leadset to ensure patient safety.
3-LEAD SETUP

The three major planes that detect electrical activity are Lead I, Lead
II, and Lead III, known as the standard or conventional bipolar limb
leads. Lead II (RA and LL), commonly known as the standard lead
configuration, is often used for monitoring because its waveform
characteristics are typically most prominent. For general monitoring
purposes, Leads I and II are most commonly used.
Lead I produces good P waves, reflecting atrial activity.
Lead II produces good QRS complexes, reflecting ventricular
activity.
Place the electrodes on the patient as shown in the illustration below.
Leads I, II, III may be selected in the monitors DISPLAY window.

RA

LA

LL

Figure 5-6: Electrode Locations for 3-Lead Setup

5 12

5 ECG

5-LEAD SETUP

Place the electrodes on the patient in the 5-lead configuration as


shown in the illustration below. Leads I, II, III, aVL, aVF, aVR, or V
may be selected in the monitors DISPLAY window.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

RA

LA

RL

LL

NOTE: See Figure 5-8: Electrode


Locations for the V Lead for V Lead
placement options.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure 5-7: Electrode Locations for 5-Lead Setup


The V lead (chest lead) in a 5-lead configuration can be placed in one
of six standard positions.
V1
V2
V3
V4
V5
V6

Figure 5-8: Electrode Locations for the V Lead

5 13

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Connecting Patient
to the Monitor

NOTE: Inspect the ECG module cable and connections regularly for
signs of mechanical damage (e.g., cracked insulation, crimped, or
bent wires).
1. Attach the electrodes as described in Lead Placement on
page 5-12 and following.
2. Press the ON/OFF or STANDBY button on the Veris monitor.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

3. Make sure the ECG function is ON.


a. Select the PARAMS menu with the menu knob.
b. Select ECG.
c. Rotate and press the menu knob to select ON.
4. Choose the appropriate lead set cable and select this on the
monitor.
a. Select the PARAMS menu with the menu knob.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

b. Select LEAD SET.


c. Rotate and press the menu knob to select the correct lead
set.
d. Select EXIT to return to the main display.
5. Connect the color-coded graphite lead wires to the
corresponding connections on the ECG module.

Figure 5-9: ECG Module Connected to Monitor


6. Connect the color-coded fiber optic cable to the corresponding
colors on the ECG module.
7. Connect the color-coded fiber optic cable to the corresponding
ECG connections on the main monitor.

5 14

5 ECG

NOTES:
To remove the fiber optic ECG cable, grip the cable connectors
at the end of the cable and pull back firmly. Do not pull on the
fiber optic cable to remove it from the monitor or ECG module.
To remove the lead set from the ECG module, grip the
connectors at the module end of the lead and pull straight out.
Do not pull on the leads themselves.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The ECG leads and connections should be inspected regularly


for signs of mechanical damage (e.g., cracked insulation,
crimped or bent wires).
8. Turn on the ECG module. The ECG module battery icon should
display on the monitor screen.
GREEN:

Communication is established and the battery is


good.

YELLOW:

Communication is established but the battery is


low.

BLACK:

Communication is not established or the battery is


dead.

An informational message should appear that the leads are not


connected to the patient.
9. Setup the display for the desired lead set combinations.
a. Select the DISPLAY menu with the menu knob.
b. Select the desired waveform.
c. Select an ECG lead combination and configure other display
parameters. See DISPLAY Softkey on page 2-28 for a
detailed description of configuring the display.
10.Keep the ECG module outside of the patient imaging volume.
NOTES:
Position the ECG module out of the imaging plane. (On the
shoulder if scanning the chest or torso or in the antecubital
space if scanning the neck or head.)
Make certain that the ECG module is stationary (not moving or
vibrating).
11.Carefully attach the color-coded lead set to the electrodes
(White=RA, Black=LA, Red=LL, Green=RL, and Brown=V),
ensuring good connections.
12.The ECG waveform(s) should display on the monitor in
approximately 5 seconds.
Completion of ECG Monitoring

To remove the ECG module cable, grip the cable connectors and pull
back firmly. Do not pull on the cable to remove it from the monitor.

5 15

MEDRAD Veris 8600

ECG Auto Lead Switching

The monitor may have the ability to display alternate leads in cases of
fault in the selected lead while the unit is set for 5 lead ECG.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The monitor uses the LL electrode in deriving all lead views.


Therefore, failure of the LL electrode results in no leads being
available. The monitor identifies the LL electrode as having failed with
the message ECG LEADS OFF. The same message displays when
both the LA and RA electrodes fail.
Lead failure assumes that the signal is lost from an electrode that is
required for the desired lead view. Loss of a signal from unnecessary
electrodes does not cause lead switching.
Primary Lead

The monitor identifies a primary lead that is used to report heart rate
numerical data. If no leads are displayed, the primary lead defaults to
lead II. If ECG waveforms are displayed, the monitor selects the
waveform closest to the top of the screen as the primary lead. Lead
switching only occurs in the primary lead view.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Lead failure during monitoring causes one of the following results:


1. If a failure occurs in the primary lead, while currently being
displayed, the system attempts to switch from the current lead
view to an alternate lead view.
The system switches to a valid (non-failed) lead view if a valid
lead exists. The failed electrode is indicated by an alarm
message. The slot label of the primary lead visibly changes to
the new lead view. The alternate waveform is drawn in the slot.
2. If the failure occurs for Lead II, while no ECG leads are
displayed, the primary lead is changed to an alternate lead. The
smart heart rate is determined from the new lead view. No lead
switching is apparent from the main screen.
3. If no alternate is available for a primary lead, an ECG: LEADS
OFF alarm is generated. The smart heart rate defaults to the
next available source, indicated by a change of the heart rate
numerical display. No lead switching occurs.
4. If the required electrodes for a displayed non-primary lead are
not available, an error message displays. The waveform
becomes a straight line. No lead switching occurs.
When the lead fail condition is corrected, the system reverts back to
the original lead that displayed before the fail condition occurred.

5 16

5 ECG

Alternate Lead Priority

The ECG monitor automatically determines lead switching as shown


below.
NOTE: Lead switching is only available in 5-lead setup.
5 Lead
Electrode Off

LL

LA

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Primary Lead

RA

RL

Alternative Lead

Lead I

NONE

II

III

Lead II

NONE

III

Lead III

NONE

II

Lead V

NONE

II

III

II

Lead aVL, aVR, aVF

NONE

II

III

In cases indicated by a dash, no switching occurs, since the electrode


is unused for that selected lead. In cases where LL fails, no switching
occurs because that electrode is required for each selectable lead
configuration.

5 17

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Gating Interface

The source of the gating signal may arise from the ECG or SpO2. The
gating signal from either of these sources may be delivered to the
scanner in two user-selectable formswaveform or pulse.
Waveform output: one of the following: 1mV ECG waveform or
a plethysmogram (SpO2) waveform.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Pulse output: 1mV pulse amplitude and 50 msec pulse width,


synchronous with the r-wave or corresponding peak of the
plethysmogram (SpO2) waveform.
The delay time from detection of the ECG signal at the patient to the
input of the MR scanner is less than or equal to 10 milliseconds.
Waveform Output
Pulse Output

One of two icons appears in the upper left corner of the heart rate
numerical display box. These icons represent the gating signal
outputeither waveform or pulse. The icon is the same color as the
ECG waveform color. See Step 6 below.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The gating function is user-selectable: OFF, ECG Waveform, ECG


Pulse, SpO2 Waveform, or SpO2 Pulse. The default is OFF.
1. Connect the MEDRAD-approved cable appropriate for the
scanner to the GATING connection on the Veris patient monitor.
NOTE: The gating cable may only be connected to equipment
that complies with IEC 950, IEC 60950, or EN 60601-1 level
electrical safety.

Figure 5-10: ECG Gating Connection

5 18

5 ECG

2. Connect the MR scanner end of the cable to the scanner


interface receptacle.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTES:
To remove the gating cable, grip the cable connectors from both
ends and pull back firmly. Do not pull on the gating cable to
remove it from the monitor or scanner.
Inspect the gating cable and connections regularly for signs of
mechanical damage (e.g., cracked insulation, crimped, or bent
wires).
3. Setup the display for the desired lead view for the gating source
in the Waveform 1 position.
a. Select the DISPLAY menu with the menu knob.
b. Select Waveform 1.
c. Select the ECG lead to use for the ECG gating source. See
DISPLAY Softkey on page 2-28 for a detailed description of
configuring the display.
4. Using the PARAMS menu select Gating and then select either
ECG Wave or ECG Pulse.
5. Configure the scanner in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations. If using the universal EGC gating cable,
always select Lead II on the scanner console.
NOTE: In the event that the desired lead view is not available,
the monitor switches to alternate lead views if possible, using
the priorities specified in ECG Auto Lead Switching on page 516.
6. An ECG waveform displays if the ECG waveform is selected for
gating. If a pulse is selected a short pulse appears in place of
the waveform. The waveform or "pulse" is transmitted to the MR
system.
NOTE: Always select LEAD 2 on the MR scanner console, with
the exception of Philips scanners. Select LEAD 3 on all Philips
scanners. If you wish to use another configuration (I, II, III, aVL,
aVR, or aVF), make this change at the Veris 8600 patient
monitor. Selecting a lead configuration other than II at the MR
scanner console may result in incorrect or no gating action.
7. The LEAD SELECT control on the patient monitor can select
either LEAD I, II, or III (or, with 5-lead configuration, aVL, aVR,
or aVF).
8. In the event one of the leads is disconnected, LEAD OFF
displays on the patient monitor screen.

5 19

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

6 NIBP
The monitor uses ComfortCuff technology to determine noninvasive blood pressure by means of oscillometry. The oscillometric
method detects volume displacements within the artery and senses
pressure variations within the blood pressure cuff during inflation.
The monitor uses cuffs ranging in size from neonate to adult thigh.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Theory of Operation

Heart Rate

The NIBP pulse rate is used if the ECG, the SpO2, and the IBP pulse
rates are not available. See Heart Rate on page 5-1 for more
information.

Comfort Cuff Technology

ComfortCuff technology measures NIBP while the cuff inflates.


Consequently, a measurement is obtained more quickly and with less
discomfort than with monitors which measure NIBP during cuff
deflation.

Description of NIBP
Measurement

The NIBP cuff begins to inflate at the beginning of the NIBP


measurement cycle. As the cuff pressure approaches the diastolic
pressure of the patient, the cuff pressure waveform begins to indicate
the pulse waveform (see Figure 6-1: NIBP Cuff Pressure and Pulse
over Time on page 6-2). The cuff pressure at this point is equal to
the patients diastolic pressure, which is stored by the monitor.
As cuff pressure continues to increase, the pulse waveform (as
measured from BP cuff pressure fluctuation) becomes stronger,
reaching its maximum at the patient's mean arterial pressure (i.e.,
when cuff pressure = mean BP). The monitor stores this value as
mean pressure.
As cuff pressure increases further, it approaches the patients systolic
pressure, and the cuffs pulse waveform decreases in amplitude. The
cuff pulse waveform disappears at the point where cuff pressure is
equal to the patients systolic pressure.
When the monitor determines that the cuff waveform has decreased
to zero amplitude, it stores the cuff pressure value as the systolic
pressure, and releases the pressure from the cuff. This typically
occurs at about 10 mmHg over the patients systolic pressure. The
cuff then rapidly deflates.

NIBP Clinical Testing


and Accuracy

This device was clinically tested per the requirements of EN 1060 and
AAMI SP-10. The NIBP module as installed in the Veris 8600 monitor
has been tested to meet the performance specifications listed in this
manual.

6 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The maximum cuff inflation rate is 15 mmHg/sec. The software limits


inflation to 300 mmHg adult, 300 mmHg pediatric, or 150 neonate. A
secondary circuit limits maximum possible cuff pressure to 316
mmHg in adult/pediatric mode and 158 mmHg in neonatal mode. Cuff
pressure is allowed to remain above 30 mmHg for a maximum of 2
minutes.
The monitor automatically deflates the cuff if the time limit is violated.
The monitor contains hardware protection for overpressure
conditions, pressure transducer failures, or microprocessor and pump
control circuit failures.
B.P Cuff Inflation Pressure
(Shown during inflation)
Systolic Pressure

Pressure in mmHg

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Cuff Inflation and


Pressure Protection

Actual Blood
Pressure Waveform
Diastolic Pressure

Cuff deflates rapidly after


monitor determines
systolic pressure

Time
Pulse Waveform
(Measured from B.P.
Cuff Pressure
Fluctuation)
Diastolic
Pressure

Mean
Pressure

Systolic
Pressure

Figure 6-1: NIBP Cuff Pressure and Pulse over Time

6 2

6 NIBP

NIBP Monitoring

The following instructions describe procedures for preparing a patient


for monitoring using the ComfortCuff NIBP module.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Shown below is the monitor with an adult size blood pressure cuff and
5 meter extension tubing. This adult arm cuff is one of many blood
pressure cuffs available. Use only NIBP accessories recommend by
MEDRAD. See Accessories in Appendix D.
The monitor has a quick connect/disconnect fitting for the NIBP
extension tubing. The patient end of the tubing has a threaded fitting
that accepts any MEDRAD NIBP cuff.

Figure 6-2: NIBP Cuff Connection

WARNING !

Check the patient frequently to ensure the NIBP cuff is not


causing prolonged impairment of the patients circulation.
Repeated use of the STAT mode should be avoided. Prolonged
or repeated use can lead to patient bruising.

6 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CAUTION !

Proper cuff size and placement is essential for accurate blood


pressure measurement.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The accuracy of noninvasive blood pressure readings may be


adversely affected by the presence of drugs or therapies which
alter the patient's cardiovascular dynamics.
The sensitivity of blood pressure measurement may be affected
when monitoring patients with intra-aortic balloon pumps.
Ensure that the NIBP extension tubing is not compressed or
restricted in any way.
NOTE: The interval timer does not start until the NIBP key is pressed.

6 4

6 NIBP

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Selecting Cuffs and Hoses

MEDRAD blood pressure cuffs and extension tubes are


recommended for use with this monitor. Use of other brands of cuffs
may cause inaccurate measurements.
Proper cuff size and placement is essential to assure accurate blood
pressure measurement. The recommended cuff width-to-length ratio
is about 2:1, so that if the cuff width is 40% of arm circumference, the
cuff bladder length encircles 80% of the arm. A cuff that is too narrow
results in falsely high pressure readings. A cuff that is too wide results
in falsely low pressure readings.
The cuff shown below on the left is too small for the arm, therefore,
full cuff pressure is never applied to the artery. This causes an
erroneously high blood pressure reading. The cuff shown on the right
is of adequate width for the arm, and full cuff pressure is applied to
the brachial artery.

Figure 6-3: Blood Pressure Cuff Size


Cuffs for thighs are available for large patients or those where neither
arm is available for cuff placement. Blood pressure measured at the
thigh is typically 20-30 mmHg higher (when the patient is standing,
not prone) than blood pressure measured at the upper arm.
Cuffs for pediatric and neonate patients are also available in a variety
of sizes. See Accessories in Appendix D for available cuffs.
If the monitor is set in the Adult mode, the monitor may inflate
Neonate/Child cuffs too quickly and result in a BP: CHECK CUFF
error. Set the monitor to Neonate mode for smaller cuff sizes.

6 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Placing the NIBP Cuff

Wrap the cuff snugly around the extremity, leaving enough room
between the cuff and the extremity for two fingers. If the cuff is too
loose, it cannot be inflated properly and may cause errors in
measured BP values.
It is best to wrap a bare extremity; putting the cuff over clothing
may cause errors in measured values.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Care should be taken to center the dot on the cuff directly over
the brachial artery. (Shown below as a circle with a vertical line).
The extension tube should not be twisted or kinked.
The end of the cuff (marked by an index line) should fall inside the
range marked clearly on the inside of the cuff. If not, use a different
size cuff.
Place this side against the skin
Este lado hacia la piel

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Ce cte en contact avec la peau

Figure 6-4: Blood Pressure Cuff Size Range

6 6

6 NIBP

Procedure

1. Check the System Status Line for the correct mode. The status
line indicates Adult, Pediatric, or Neonate.
2. Select a cuff as described previously in this section.
3. Connect the BP cuff to the extension tube.
4. Connect the extension tube to the monitor.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

5. Secure the cuff around the patients extremity.


6. Make sure there are no kinks or other obstructions in the
extension tube extending from the cuff.
7. Press the NIBP key on the front keypad of the monitor.
Pressing the NIBP key causes the monitor to take one measurement.
The monitor may make a second attempt if there is excessive motion
during the first attempt to take a measurement.
Press momentarily the NIBP CYCLE/STAT key to begin taking Stat
NIBP measurements. NIBP measurements are then taken repetitively
for 5 minutes. The numerical parameters on the display are updated
with each measurement.
If an NIBP cycle time has been selected the monitor automatically
takes NIBP measurements at scheduled intervals. Press the NIBP
key to begin measuring at automatic intervals.
If the monitor is placed in STANDBY MODE or AGENT ALARM
STANDBY MODE, the monitor does not take NIBP cycle time
readings.

6 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Taking NIBP Measurements

For optimum accuracy, the patient should keep the cuffed part of the
arm at the same level as the heart. NIBP measurement points above
the level of the heart give reduced pressure values. Measurement
points below the heart level give increased values. These errors are
due to the weight of the blood.

Heart

Figure 6-5: Arm Position for NIBP Measurement


An average measurement on a non-moving patient takes less than 40
seconds. At the end of each measurement, the cuff automatically
deflates. The monitor automatically attempts a second measurement
(with no displayed error message) if it cannot calculate a blood
pressure on the first inflation.
If a patient experiences a sudden dramatic drop in blood pressure,
the system may not measure the blood pressure on the first attempt.
The system automatically attempts another pressure measurement,
and detects the change on the second attempt.
Do not compress the cuff or the extension tube externally.
Compression of the cuff or the extension tube causes measurement
error. For optimum accuracy, the patient should remain still during
blood pressure measurement. Excessive patient motion may
adversely affect any oscillometric NIBP device.

6 8

7 SpO2
Theory of Operation

The monitor uses Digital Oximetry (DOX) technology to measure


blood oxygen saturation (SpO2).
Heart Rate

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Definition

The SpO2 pulse rate is used if the ECG and the IBP pulse rates are
not available. See Heart Rate on page 5-1 for more information.
Hemoglobin exists in the blood in several forms:
Oxygenated (Oxyhemoglobin)
Reduced (Deoxyhemoglobin)
Dyshemoglobins (carboxyhemoglobin and methemoglobin.)
In the monitor, SpO2 (pulse arterial oxygen saturation) is the ratio of
oxygenated hemoglobin to the sum of oxygenated hemoglobin plus
hemoglobin which is available for binding to oxygen, as expressed in
the following formula:
oxyhemoglobin
percent oxygen saturation = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 100
oxyhemoglobin + deoxyhemoglobin

Dyshemoglobins, such as carboxyhemoglobin and methemoglobin,


are not directly measured and therefore are not factored into the
measurement.
DOX Digital Oximetry

The monitor does not use analog circuitry for signal processing.
Digital signal processing in the microprocessor results in lower noise
from circuitry components, resulting in a cleaner signal and better
performance under low perfusion conditions. There is also improved
rejection of noise from the patient and environment, due to the
availability of the true, unfiltered sensor signal for digital signal
processing.

Method

The digital pulse oximeter measures oxygen saturation and pulse rate
using the principles of spectrophotometry and plethysmography. The
sensor is completely non-invasive, and there is no heat source that
could burn the patient.
The pulse oximeter sensor contains two types of LEDs. Each type
emits a specific wavelength of light. Since oxygenated hemoglobin
and deoxygenated hemoglobin absorb light selectively and
predictably, the amounts of these two compounds can be determined
by measuring the intensity of each wavelength that passes through
the measuring site.

7 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The light from the LEDs shines into a pulsating vascular bed. A
photodetector located opposite or alongside the LEDs measures the
intensity of each wavelength transmitted through the monitoring site.
The light intensity is converted to an electrical signal, which is input to
the monitor. The effects of skin pigmentation, venous blood, and
other tissue constituents are eliminated by separating out the
pulsating absorption data.
SpO2 Clinical Testing
and Accuracy

The Veris oximeter has SpO2 calibration tables which were originally
generated by monitoring desaturated human patients or volunteers
and matching their displayed SpO2 value to the value determined by
sampling arterial blood and measuring functional SaO2 with a clinical
laboratory grade multi wavelength optical oximeter (i.e. CO-oximeter).
The final SpO2 calibration curve was then generated based upon
numerous patients' data over the range of 40 to 99% SaO2. All
accepted data were taken from patients with dyshemoglobin (i.e.,
carboxyhemoglobin, methemoglobin) concentrations near zero.
This oximeter is a two-wavelength device, which is calibrated to
measure functional SpO2 only when dyshemoglobin concentrations
are near zero. The accuracy specifications of this device will not be
met with high concentrations of dyshemoglobins. Significant
concentrations of carboxyhemoglobin results in a higher displayed
SpO2 value than is actually present in the patient.
Special MR-compatible sensors help provide for patient safety in the
MR environment because the sensor cable is made of a material that
does not conduct electricity even if the cable is looped within the MR
scanner. For the same reason, the sensor and cable are immune to
electromagnetic interference, such as might be produced by high
frequency (HF) surgical equipment. Each MR-compatible sensor
uses a fiber optic light guide to carry light from the light sources to the
patient. A separate light guide brings light, which has passed through
the patient, to the light detector. The light sources and detector are
located in the connector housing of the fiber optic sensor.

Gating Signals

The input gating signal is derived from any one of two sourcesECG
or Plethysmogram (SpO2) waveform and is available in 2 userselectable forms, pulse or waveform. An icon of the gating signal
source and a visual indication appears at the upper left corner of the
heart rate numerical display box.
SPO2 GATING

SpO2 gating is dependent upon the patient's peripheral perfusion at


the location where the sensor is placed. The pulse oximeter sensor is
placed on the selected location of the patient. The signal generated
from the patient's pulse is transmitted through fiber optic cables to the
transducer portion of the SpO2 cable where it is converted to an
electrical signal. The electrical signal is sent to the Veris monitor and
then to the scanner which may be used to trigger the sequence.

7 2

7 SpO2

SpO2 Monitoring Procedures


(Pulse Oximetry)

The following instructions describe procedures for preparing a patient


for SpO2 monitoring.
There are three SpO2 sensors available:
Adult finger-toe clip
Pediatric finger-toe clip
Neonate probe

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Shown below are two of these attached to a sensor extension cable.


The sensor is connected to the Veris monitor by means of an
extension cable. The sensor extension cable contains electrically
conductive material. Do not extend or coil the SpO2 sensor extension
cable into the magnet bore.
The monitor's SpO2 extension cable accepts only fiber optic sensors.

Adult Finger Probe

Neonate Probe

Figure 7-1: Sensor Connection for SpO2

7 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CAUTION !

The pulse oximeter sensor may cause skin irritation and


pressure necrosis. Inspect the pulse oximeter sensor site every
two to four hours or per hospital protocol. Move the sensor to a
different location if skin irritation is present.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not bend fiber optic cables too tightly. The SpO2 fiber optic
cable should have a minimum bend radius of 5.1 cm (2 inches).
Excessive amounts of motion at the sensor sites may cause
errors in reading. Attempt a reading when motion has stopped,
or move the sensor to another site.
The sensor extension cable contains electrically conductive
material. Do not coil or extend the sensor extension cable into
the magnet bore!
To remove the SpO2 connector, grip the connector's retaining
ring (in the middle of the connector) and pull back gently. The
retaining ring slides back and unlocks the connector. Do not
attempt to unscrew.
Attaching the Probe
to the Monitor

1. Press the ON/OFF or STANDBY button to turn on the monitor.


2. Connect the SpO2 sensor extension cable to the monitor. Align
the red dot on the monitors SpO2 receptacle with the red dot on
the black SpO2 connector housing. Push the connector firmly
into the receptacle.
3. Select the appropriate probe and attach the probe to the patient
(refer to the next section). Attach the probe's connector to the
SpO2 sensor extension cable.

Attaching the Probe


to the Patient

Select the appropriate probe and application technique from the


following pictures and descriptions. The selected probe should be
cleaned before use.

CAUTION !

Attaching the probe too tightly to the skin may generate


inaccurate readings (by reducing blood flow to the target area)
and cause blisters on the patient's skin. (Lack of skin
respiration, not heat, causes the blisters.)
The protection against the effects of electric shock of the Pulse
oximeter function is of type CF. This protection is contained in
the fiber optic sensor cable.

7 4

7 SpO2

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

CAUTION !

Fiber optic sensors can be damaged if subjected to severe


stress, such as pulling, bending, or crushing. The sensor
(including the sensor extension cable) should not be stepped
on, jerked or bent into a very tight arc (radius less than 2
inches). It is recommended to use tape to strain-relieve the fiber
optic cable to the patient couch before attaching the sensor to
the patient.
Reposition the probe at least once every 24 hours to allow the
patient's skin to respire.
Do not extend or coil the SpO2 sensor extension cable into the
magnet bore. There is a potential for thermal heating of the
extension cable, caused by the interaction between the MR
systems RF energy and the electrically conductive sensor
extension cable.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Use only oximeter probes supplied with, or specifically intended


for use with, the Veris 8600 patient monitor.
Significant levels of dysfunctional hemoglobins, such as
carboxyhemoglobin or methemoglobin, affects the accuracy of
the SpO2 measurement.
SpO2 measurement may be affected in the presence of high
ambient light. Shield the probe area (with a surgical towel, for
example) if necessary.
Dyes introduced into the bloodstream, such as methylene blue,
indocyanine green, indigo carmine and fluorescein, may result
in inaccurate SpO2 readings.
Any condition that restricts blood flow, such as use of a blood
pressure cuff or extremes in systemic vascular resistance, may
cause an inability to determine accurate pulse and SpO2
readings.
The light source portion of the SpO2 sensor must be properly
positioned over the nail bed for the plethysmographic waveform
to appear.
The SpO2 waveform display is not necessarilly directly
proportional to pulse volume. The SpO2 waveform display is not
automatically gain adjusted.
Remove fingernail polish or false fingernails before applying
SpO2 probes. Fingernail polish or false fingernails may cause
inaccurate SpO2 readings.

7 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Finger Probe Application


for Adults

1. Attach the finger probe to the patient as shown. Be sure to fully


insert the patient's finger into the probe. Run the fiber optic
cable away from the hand. For patients with long fingernails, use
the neonatal probe.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Apply the sensor with the light source positioned directly over
the nail-bed, and the detector over the fleshy portion of the
finger.
NOTES:
Do not tape over the pulse oximeter sensor housing. Taping
over the housing may cause injury and sensor failure due to
excessive pressure. If the sensor needs to be secured, place
tape over the cable, immediately behind the sensor.
The sensor must be properly positioned for a plethysmographic
waveform to appear. Placing tape too tightly around an extremity
reduces blood flow, thus diminishing the amplitude of the
plethysmographic waveform.
If possible, do not place the pulse oximeter sensor on the same
extremity as the blood pressure cuff or an arterial line. Place the
pulse oximeter sensor on the side of the patient opposite the
blood pressure cuff or an arterial line. The occlusion of the blood
flow during blood pressure determinations could affect
saturation readings.
The pulse oximeter sensor is light sensitive. Too much ambient
light makes it difficult for the system to provide accurate
readings. The system provides a high ambient light alarm
message when it is necessary to shield the sensor from
extraneous light sources such as phototherapy light or infrared
heating lamps.

Figure 7-2: Finger Sensor Placement

7 6

7 SpO2

Neonate Probe Placement

In situations where a finger sensor is not practical, a MEDRAD


neonate probe can be used. The sensor pads are small, light-weight,
and adjustable.
The neonate probe can be placed using adhesive tape. Special care
should be taken not to restrict blood flow in the finger tip.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

TAPE PREPARATION OF NEONATE PROBE

Attach the two sides of the neonate probe to a pre punched neonate
tape strip as shown in Figure 7-3: Tape Prep for Neonate Probe
Placement. When using the neonate probe on a toe, it can be helpful
to cut the tape strip along the length.
Light Source Side

2.8cm
(1.1)

Windows

Fibers
Optic
Cables

Detector Side

Figure 7-3: Tape Prep for Neonate Probe Placement


FINGER

NOTE: Proper application of the neonate probe on the finger is


essential. See Figure 7-4: Neonate Probe Finger Placement

Incorrect

Correct

Figure 7-4: Neonate Probe Finger Placement


1. Attach the neonate probe to a pre punched neonate tape strip
as shown in Figure 7-3: Tape Prep for Neonate Probe
Placement.

7 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Remove the backing from the light source side of the neonate
tape.
Light
Source
Side

Figure 7-5: Neonate Probe Tape


3. Attach the neonate probe to the patient with the light source
side to the fingernail.
4. Line up the light source side with the detector side so the source
and detector are in the same plane.
NOTE: The fiber optic cables run along the finger toward the
wrist.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

5. Remove the backing from the remaining portion of the tape and
secure the probe and cable. Do not over-tighten the tape.
TOE

1. Attach the neonate probe to a pre punched neonate tape strip.


2. Remove the backing from the light source side of the neonate
tape. See Figure 7-5: Neonate Probe Tape on page 7-8.
3. Attach the probe to the patient's toe as shown with the light
source side on the toenail.
NOTE: The fiber optic cables run along the foot toward the heel.
4. Remove the backing from the center section of the neonate
tape. See Figure 7-5: Neonate Probe Tape on page 7-8.
5. Line up the light source with the detector side so the source and
detector are in the same plane.
6. Remove the backing from the remaining portion of the tape and
secure the sensor and cable with neonate tape being careful not
to over-tighten the tape.
Neonate Tape Strips

Figure 7-6: Neonate Probe Toe Placement

7 8

7 SpO2

FOOT (INFANTS)

1. Attach the neonate probe to a neonate tape strip.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Remove the backing from the light source side of the neonate
tape. See Figure 7-5: Neonate Probe Tape on page 7-8.
3. Attach the neonate probe to the infant's foot as shown in Figure
7-7: Neonate Probe Foot Placement (Infants), just behind the
small toe. Attach the sensor with the light source side on the top
or outside of the foot to keep the detector side away from
ambient light.
4. Line up the light source side with the detector side, so the
source and detector are in the same plane.
5. Remove the backing from the remaining portion of the tape and
secure the neonate probe with neonate tape, being careful not
to over-tighten the tape.
Light Source
(Top of Foot)
Neonate
Tape Strip

Detector

Figure 7-7: Neonate Probe Foot Placement (Infants)

7 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Peripheral (SpO2) gating provides an alternative to ECG gating. (See


Gating Interface on page 5-18.) It utilizes the signal obtained from
the pulse oximeter sensor.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

SpO2 Peripheral Gating

Figure 7-8: SpO2 Peripheral Gating Connection


The pulse oximeter signal is obtained from the patient and displayed
on the monitor. To utilize the peripheral gating function on the monitor
a cable is attached to the GATING connector of the monitor with the
distal end connected to the SpO2 receptacle of the MR scanner.
NOTE: Gating cables are scanner specific. If a specific cable does
not exist for your particular scanner, the universal cable may be used.
The source of the gating signal may arise from the ECG or SpO2. The
gating signal from either of these sources may be delivered to the
scanner in two user-selectable formswaveform or pulse.
The delay time from detection of the SpO2 signal at the patient to the
input of the MR scanner is less than or equal to 20 milliseconds.

7 10

7 SpO2

Waveform Output
Pulse Output

One of two icons appears in the upper left corner of the heart rate
numerical display box. These icons represent the gating signal
outputeither waveform or pulse. The icon is the same color as the
SpO2 waveform color when SpO2 is selected for gating.
The gating function is user-selectable: OFF, ECG Waveform, ECG
Pulse, SpO2 Waveform, or SpO2 Pulse. The default is OFF.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1. Connect the cable appropriate for the scanner to the GATING


connection on the Veris patient monitor.
NOTE: The gating cable must be IEC 950 or IEC 60950
compliant.
2. Connect the MR scanner end of the cable to the scanner
interface receptacle.
NOTES:
To remove the gating cable, grip the cable connectors from both
ends and pull back firmly. Do not pull on the gating cable to
remove it from the monitor or scanner.
Inspect the gating cable and connections regularly for signs of
mechanical damage (e.g., cracked insulation, crimped, or bent
wires).
3. With the menu knob select the PARAMS menu.
4. At Gating select either SpO2 Wave or SpO2 Pulse.
5. Configure the scanner in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations.

7 11

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

8 IBP

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Theory of Operation

The IBP monitoring module is intended for direct pressure monitoring


using an intra-arterial catheter, a continuous flushing system, and an
IBP transducer. The IBP module provides analog to digital conversion
of the transducer signal.
The IBP module processes continuous digital patient data that can be
displayed as waveform and numerical values. The module supports
up to two separate IBP channels simultaneously. For arterial and
pulmonary artery IBP measurements the numerical values for
systolic, diastolic, and mean pressure are computed and displayed.
Heart Rate

Method of Measurement

The IBP pulse rate is used if the ECG pulse rate data is unavailable.
See Heart Rate on page 5-1 for more information.
The IBP module uses standard invasive pressure monitoring
techniques. A bridge transducer is measured by a highly accurate
analog to digital converter. The measuring circuit uses a 5 volt
excitation voltage that provides a transfer function of 25 micro-volts
per mmHg of pressure.
The signal is buffered and brought to the A/D converter, which is
configured for a full scale signal of 25 millivolts. The circuit has a
potential measuring range of 1000 mmHg of pressure. This range is
restricted to -20 to +300 mmHg for actual monitoring purposes.
There is no analog amplification of the transducer signal.
The module uses a rate of 50 samples per second for each of the two
independent IBP channels. The resulting measurement resolution is
slightly less than 0.5 mmHg. The numerical IBP value is reported by
the 8600 monitor at a resolution of 1 mmHg.
Non-pulsatile IBP sites (LA, RA, CVP, or ICP) are reported as mean
numerical values. The non-pulsatile mean value is an average of the
last 200 samples taken over a period of approximately 4 seconds.
The values for pulsatile sites (ART, PA, RV, and LV) are reported as
an average of the last eight calculated values.
The IBP heart rate is reported as an average of the last 16 heart rate
values. The software also scans for sudden changes in heart rate and
overrides the averaging function when the condition occurs.

IBP Clinical Testing


and Accuracy

The invasive blood pressure module is in compliance with applied


standard IEC 60601-2-34 and has been tested to meet the
performance specifications listed in this manual. The module as
installed in the Veris monitor has been clinically tested for
performance with a variety of patients and specific disposable
invasive blood pressure transducers.

8 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Invasive Blood Pressure (IBP) allows monitoring of Real-Time


Invasive Blood Pressure with the use of a Blood Pressure Transducer.
The transducer converts the hydrostatic signals into electrical signals
which are displayed graphically on the monitor.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

IBP Monitoring

Disposable
Intravenous
Sets
IBP
Interface
Cables

Transducers

Figure 8-1: IBP Cable Connections with Interface Cables, Patient Connections

8 2

8 IBP

Invasive Blood Pressure


Transducers and Interface
Cables

As for all accessories, cables and transducers should comply with UL


and IEC standards for medical equipment. Use only pressure
transducers which have been recommended by MEDRAD. Please
note that MEDRAD does not sell or distribute transducers. The
following are examples of disposable transducers which meet the
Medrad specification of an electrical cable that does not exceed 14
inches in length:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Edwards/Baxter Truwave (REF PX600F & PX260)


!

WARNING !

Use transducers whose electrical cable length does not exceed


14 inches. Failure to follow this instruction could produce a
patient burn or shock hazard resulting in serious injury or death.
IBP Interface Cable

There is an IBP interface cable available for the transducer listed


above. This cable can be connected to the monitor through IBP1
(Port Channel 1), IBP2 (Port Channel 2), or both.
Transducer specifications and the interface cable which fits each
specific type are listed in Appendix F: "IBP Transducer
Specifications.
!

WARNING !

There is a possible shock hazard if incorrect IBP pressure


sensors are used.
Failure to follow proper invasive blood pressure monitoring and
insertion techniques may cause clots leading to cerebral or
pulmonary embolism resulting in serious patient injury or death.
Follow all manufacturers instructions and precautions provided
with the transducer and intra-arterial catheter.
Do not coil or extend the IBP interface cable in the magnet bore.
This could result in patient shock or burn. All cables must be
straight, not coiled, and routed down the center of the scanner
table.
Use transducers with an electrical cable length of 14 or less.

8 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CAUTION !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not place the IBP transducer in the bore of the magnet. This
could result in degraded measurement accuracy. Ensure the
transducer is outside of the magnet bore.
Place only the disposable tubing portion of the IBP kit in the
magnet bore to ensure patient safety and improve measurement
accuracy. Use a disposable set which is a minimum of four feet
(1219 mm) in length.
Calibrate (zero), the transducer when changing or modifying
transducer tubing.
When changing or modifying a transducer tubing set, ensure
that the entire fluid path is free of air bubbles. Do not allow air
bubbles to enter the the catheter.

8 4

8 IBP

IBP Monitoring Procedure

The following instructions describe procedures for preparing a patient


for invasive blood pressure monitoring. We recommend IBP
transducers that have a required specification of 5 microvolts/mmHg.
and the frequency response at 20 hertz. There are several to choose
from.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Each IBP channel has its own dedicated IBP port that is located on
the side of the monitor.

IBP Port Channel 1


IBP Port Channel 2

Figure 8-2: IBP Ports


The IBP ports are customized 5-pin female sockets and are designed
to accept only MEDRAD compatible IBP interface cables.
The transducer specifications and information for obtaining
transducer cables is located in Appendix F: "IBP Transducer
Specifications of this manual.

8 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

IBP Safety

WARNING !

Possible shock hazard. Avoid using metal components in IBP


fluid systems.
Do not extend the distal portion of the transducer with the microchip into the bore of the magnet.
!

The accuracy of invasive blood pressure readings may be


adversely affected when used on patients with intra-aortic
balloon pumps.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

CAUTION !

For accurate performance, IBP transducers must conform to the


specification designated by MEDRAD, Inc. Follow the
instructions provided with your transducer.
Accuracy of the IBP measurement can be affected by poor
setup of the transducer or fluid system. Follow hospital protocols
for invasive blood pressure monitoring.
Setup and User Calibration

The IBP monitoring system requires the clinician to periodically


calibrate the monitor. The air vent stopcock of the transducer is
opened and the transducer is exposed to the ambient room pressure.
The monitor reads the transducer signal and makes adjustments to
compensate for small changes in the transducer and/or ambient
pressure.
This operation is described as having zeroed the IBP monitor. Each
time a new IBP site is setup, the clinician must zero that channel. The
channels may be zeroed together or independently.
Although waveforms are always present, the monitor does not show
numerical values until the monitor is zeroed. While the monitor
calibrates, it is possible to observe the correction of the waveform.
The monitor must be zeroed when:
The monitor is powered up.
The transducer is changed or the cable is re-inserted.
The patient size is changed; Adult, Pediatric, or Neonatal Mode.
It is recommended that the IBP channels be zeroed at least every 8
hours when sustained IBP monitoring is necessary.
To zero the IBP channels for monitoring:
1. Setup the IBP fluid system and transducer according to hospital
protocols.
2. Verify that the correct alarm limits are entered into the ALARMS
window of the monitor.

8 6

8 IBP

3. Connect the IBP interface cable to the Veris monitor.


4. Connect the appropriate IBP interface cable to the transducer.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

5. The monitor displays the message NOT ZEROED in the


informational alarm line. The message appears independently
for each channel.
NOTE: If a waveform slot is set to display IBP, the monitor
shows a waveform immediately. This waveform is representative
of the physiological patient data, but is not yet scaled until the
IBP lines are properly zeroed. No numerical values are
displayed for a channel until it has been zeroed.
6. Select PARAMS and open the first window of parameters.
EXIT
HR Source
Gating
ECG
Cable
Filter
Display Range
Auto lead switching
Color
IBP 1
IBP 2

Smart
OFF
ON
5 lead
Monitor
MEDIUM
YES

SITE ART RANGE 0 TO 200


SITE CVP RANGE 0 TO 20

ZERO None Color


ZERO None Color

NIBP
NIBP tone
Color

ON
NONE

ECG/IBP/SPO2 Tone Vol


Other Params Menus

5
No Action

GASES

ON

Figure 8-3: Setting IBP in the PARAMS Window


NOTE: The example window shown contains factory default
values. Reset the parameters as required for actual monitoring
conditions.
7. Verify that the channels are set to the correct IBP sites.
8. Verify that the pressure range is set correctly.
9. Set the transducer to the zero calibration position. Generally this
requires opening a stopcock on the transducer to allow an
ambient room pressure reading. Follow the directions for your
transducer.
10.Go to the PARAMS window by selecting and pressing the
PARAMS softkey with the menu knob.

8 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

11.Go to the IBP 1 or IBP 2 parameters. Move the cursor to the


ZERO selection item in the PARAMS window. Set ZERO to One
to begin zero calibration.
NOTE: The ZERO setting can be changed to All to begin zero
calibration of both IBP channels at the same time. The stopcock
must be open on each transducer to be zeroed.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

12.When you zero the channel, numerical values appear in the IBP
box in the lower right corner of the main display. The message
ZERO GOOD briefly appears.
13.Exit the PARAMS window.
14.Return the transducer to its normal monitoring position. The
numerical values for pulsatile IBP sites appears and displayed
IBP waveforms resume their normal shape.
NOTE: the monitor cannot calibrate to a zero offset that exceeds
150 mmHg. The monitor reports a ZERO FAIL message. Contact
MEDRAD Service or your local representative if you cannot zero the
monitor.
NOTE: The transducer can not calibrate at an elevation of 2,000
meters (6,561.7 ft.).
Zero Calibration (Quick)

You can quickly zero the IBP channels using the softkeys on the main
menu.
1. Open the transducers to atmosphere pressure.
2. Turn the menu knob to highlight ZERO IBP1 (or ZERO IBP2) from
the main menu.
3. Press in the menu knob to begin the zero calibration of the
selected IBP channel.
4. Wait until the message ZERO GOOD appears in the alarms
message area.
5. Close the transducers.

8 8

8 IBP

Clinical Use and


Arterial Waveforms

A variety of physiological conditions alters the appearance of the IBP


pressure waveforms. Conditions such as hypertension, shock,
obstruction of the aorta, aortic valve disease, and pericarditis can
affect the arterial pressure waveform.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The arterial waveforms may also be affected by poor setup. The more
common problems affecting arterial waveforms are overdamping,
catheter whip and lack of periodic calibration.
Overdamping is caused by air bubbles, thrombus formation at the tip
of the catheter, or lodging of the catheter tip against the vessel wall.
Overdamping exhibits itself as a poorly defined waveform without a
noticeable dicrotic notch.
Catheter whip is caused by excessive movement of the catheter tip
within the vessel. Catheter whip exhibits itself as an erratic or noisy
waveform.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

As described above, zero the IBP channels at least every eight hours
or according to hospital protocol.
Disparity between invasive and non-invasive blood pressure values
normally occurs due to the difference in the measurement technique.
Cuff pressure (NIBP) tends to be 5 to 10 mmHg lower than invasive
(IBP) measurements. This disparity can be even more pronounced in
hypothermic patients and with poorly arranged IBP tubing.
NOTE: Position transducers at the same height as the patients heart
for optimal measurement accuracy.

8 9

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

9 Temperature

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Theory of Operation

The Veris monitor uses a fiber-optic thermometer to measure


temperature. This provides accurate and reliable measurements in
the MRI environment.
This sensor probe features an environmentally inert, non-conductive,
non-metallic, miniature probe, making it ideal for harsh operating
conditions like the MRI environment, which includes conditions where
high levels of electromagnetic interference (EMI) such as RF field or
high voltages exist. The probe itself is inert to chemical and biological
agents and is ideally suited to applications where a completely nonreactive sensor is required or where other types of sensors would
malfunction or become damaged.
Temperature-sensitive
Phosphor

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Optical Fiber

Incident pulse of LED Time-decaying phosphor


emission pulse returns to
energizes phosphor;
spontaneous emission detection circuitry
occurs

Figure 9-1: Temperature Probe Signals


The temperature system is comprised of a probe, a fiber optic cable,
detection optics, and signal processing, and interfaces contained
within the main monitor. The probe itself contains a patented, highly
temperature-sensitive phosphor as its sensing element, and both the
probe and phosphor are protected by a fluoropolymer sheath. The
standard cable length is 3 meters.
The temperature system uses a fluorodecay sensing technique.
Pulsed light from an LED is sent down the optical fiber to energize the
phosphor. The time decaying glow of the phosphor changes with
temperature and is transmitted back to the sensor head where it is
converted to a temperature reading. The temperature system uses a
unique ratio measurement system to minimize inaccuracies due to
signal loss from the fiber and connector.
The temperature system is fully calibrated at the factory. Each probe
contains its own calibration data within an embedded memory
module.

9 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The Veris monitor system provides for two temperature probes,


allowing for patient temperature measurements from two different
locations. The user is not required to use both probes simultaneously
nor is one probe dominant over the other.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Temperature Monitoring
Procedures

Figure 9-2: Temperature Probe Connection


Skin surface temperature monitoring is intended for the detection of
hypothermic and hyperthermic conditions. The skin temperature
sensor is designed for placement on the surface of the skin only.
To insure the proper performance of the temperature accessories,
follow the precautions listed below.
!

CAUTION !

Forced mating of the connectors without proper alignment may


cause damage to the connectors and interruption in electrical
continuity and optical alignment.
During use, do not entwine the cable with other electrical
cables.
To remove the temperature connector, press on the locking clip
and pull straight out. Do not pull on the temperature sensor
cable to remove the temperature connector from the monitor.

9 2

9 Temperature

.
!

CAUTION !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not bend fiber optic cables too tightly. The temperature fiber
optic cable should have a minimum bend radius of 7.6 cm
(3 inches).
Fiber optic sensors can be damaged if subjected to severe
stress, such as pulling, bending, or crushing. The sensor
(including the connector cable) should not be stepped on,
jerked, or bent into a very tight arc (radius less than 3 cm). It is
recommended to use tape to strain relieve the fiber optic cable
to the patient couch before attaching the sensor to the patient.
Reposition the probe at least once every 24 hours to allow the
patient's skin to respire.

9 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Directions for Use with


Skin Surface Probe
Preparing the Equipment

1. Press the ON/OFF or STANDBY button to turn on the monitor.


Check the monitor settings for the correct setup.
2. Connect the temperature probes to the monitor.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: Take care to align the temperature sensor plug so that


the locking clip on the plug lines up correctly with the receptacle
on the side of the monitor. Forced mating of the connectors
without proper alignment may cause damage to the connectors
and interruption in electrical continuity.
NOTE: The monitors temperature connection accepts any
MEDRAD fiber-optic temperature accessory.
3. Unwind the cable from the protective card and peel the sensor
from the card.
Attaching the Temperature Probe
to the Patient

MEDRAD recommends attaching the temperature probes at either


the Axillary or Femoral location as shown in Figure 9-2: Temperature
Probe Locations below.

Femoral

Axillary

Figure 9-3: Temperature Probe Locations


4. Prepare the skin site according to established protocol. Prepare
the patient by ensuring that any hair is removed from the
location(s) where you intend to place the temperature probe(s).
5. Adhere the sensor to the skin site. Apply tape length-wise along
the cable, directly over the flouroptic sensor as well as to the
cable sheath.
Cleaning Probes

To clean the temperature probes, see Temperature on page A-3 in


Maintenance in Appendix A.

9 4

10 Anesthetic Agents
Theory of Operations

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Integrated CO2 and Agent


Gas Detector

The Veris monitor uses the sidestream method of measuring CO2 and
anesthetic agent gases. Gas is drawn through a nasal cannula or
sample line. The gas sample enters the monitor from a sampling tube
into a water trap, which removes water vapor and particulate matter
from the gas sample. The gas then enters the CO2 (agent) detector
where it is analyzed.
Agent Gas Measurement

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The integrated detector measures carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrous oxide


(N2O), and five halogenated anesthetic agent gases using the same
sample collection path and testing apparatus. The analyzer uses
proprietary High IQ technology to identify and quantify agent
gases. There are no moving parts, reducing size of the detector and
enhancing reliability.

The agent detector samples gas breathed by the patient through a


sidestream circuit. It measures the concentrations of CO2, N2O, and
halogenated anesthetic agents in the sampled gas. The detector
uses far-infrared measurements to identify concentrations of
halothane, enflurane, isoflurane, sevoflurane, desflurane anesthetic
agents and their mixtures.
The analyzer uses the principles of infrared absorption spectrometry
to measure anesthetic gases. The integrated detector determines the
concentrations of anesthetic gases and CO2 by measuring the optical
absorption of the sampled patient gas at a number of specific
wavelengths in the medium to long-wave infrared region.
AGENT ACCURACY OF MEASUREMENT

The accuracy of a single agent measurement is defined by the


formula,

where m is equal to the measurement in percent and x is the


tolerance range.
Example of 5% HAL measurement, calculating the high limit of the
tolerance range.
(5% HAL 0.04Reading) + 0.1%Absolute = 0.3%
5% HAL + 0.3%Tolerance = 5.3%
Final tolerance range is 4.7% to 5.3% HAL.

10 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Gas Monitoring Procedures

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Sampling Circuit Connections

The following instructions describe procedures for preparing a patient


for CO2, O2, N2O, and agent (AGT) monitoring.
The monitor uses a sidestream gas sampling circuit composed of a
water trap, a sampling line and a sampling device. The water trap is a
combination filter and moisture condenser. The same circuit is used
for CO2, O2, N2O, and agent monitoring.
Shown below is the patient monitor with a water trap and sample line
connection. Please refer to Accessories in Appendix D for part
numbers.

Figure 10-1: Gas Sampling Connection


The monitors gas sampling connection (from the water trap) accepts
gas sampling lines using the Luer style connections. It is important to
use the recommended water trap and combinations in order to
provide the correct flow rates for monitoring purposes.

10 2

10 Anesthetic Agents

Gas Monitoring Safety The following instructions describe precautions and contraindications
for gas monitoring. Use all safety procedures and protocols for
anesthetic safety as designated by your health care facility.

WARNING !

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not use this monitoring system in conjunction with highly


flammable anesthetics such as cyclopropane or ether.
The monitoring system is not intended for monitoring gas
mixtures containing methoxyflurane or halogenated
hydrocarbons not specifically listed as a monitored gas.
Environmental pollution of nitrous oxide and halogenated
agents may cause accuracy errors. Always use anesthetic gas
scavenging systems (AGSS) with the monitoring system.
Infectious agents may be transferred between patients through
the return of the monitor's exhaust to the patient's breathing
circuit.
Do not connect the monitors exhaust for return flow to the
breathing circuit. Infectious agents may be transmitted through
reverse flow from sampling devices.
Infectious agents may be transferred between patients through
contaminated masks and nasal cannulas. Change the sample
device and sampling line before use with each new patient.
Never attach intravenous tubes to gas sampling connections.
Gas sampling lines may be inadvertently connected to
intravascular fluid systems; allowing air into a blood vessel.
Do not pinch, roll over, step on, or yank gas monitoring lines.
Only use MEDRAD MRI compliant supplied gas cylinders for
verification of gas readings. They are suitable for use in the MRI
environment. See Accessories in Appendix D for part
numbers.

CAUTION !

Use only MEDRAD water traps with this monitor.


Care should be taken to prevent gas tubing from being
obstructed in any way by the scanner table or other equipment.
Change sample lines and sampling devices between each
patient. Infectious agents may be transmitted through reuse of
sampling lines.
Use of longer sampling lines or extensions increases the
monitors response time and can affect accuracy.

10 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Water Trap

The water trap has a connection located at the top that fits up and
into the gas receptacle of the monitor.
Water Trap Receptacle
(On Monitor)

Luer-lock entrance

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Water Trap
Connection

Water Trap
Slide up and into
receptacle

Figure 10-2: WaterChek 2+ Water Trap


The trap slides out of the front receptacle and can be quickly replaced
if it becomes filled or occluded. The front of the WaterChek 2+ water
trap has a female Luer-lock sampling line entrance.

10 4

10 Anesthetic Agents

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Sampling Devices

Shown below is a typical gas sampling device (nasal cannula)


attached to a sample line. This nasal cannula is used for both CO2,
O2, N2O, and agent (AGT) monitoring.

Figure 10-3: Nasal Cannula


If using the nasal cannula, position it directly under the patient's nose
with the prongs extending into the nostrils. Slide the adjuster forward
to close the loop around the head.
The nasal cannula is intended for single patient use only. Alternate
sampling devices such as masks may be used if they have a female
Luer-locking sampling entrance. Intubation breathing circuits require
a sampling entrance near the connection to the endotracheal tube.
The divided nasal cannula delivers O2 and samples for CO2.
Intubated Patients

The monitor can be used with intubated patients. Use recommended


water traps and breath circuit adaptors. Check the trap reservoirs
regularly. Check the breath circuit regularly for leaks or
disconnections. Follow the directions provided with your endotracheal
tube for additional precautions.

CAUTION !

Additional adaptors between the endotracheal tube and the


sampling entrance should not exceed five centimeters.

10 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Standard breath circuit configurations are shown below beginning


with a common endotracheal tube with a 15mm outside diameter. The
circuit then extends to meet a standard 22mm inside diameter
ventilation flex tube. Confirm the proper fit of all breath circuit
components before attempting patient monitoring.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Sampling Line (Luer-lock)

22mm I.D. Ventilation Tube


with 15mm I.D. Adaptor

Endotracheal
Tube 15mm O.D.

15mm I.D./15mm O.D.


Ventilation Adaptor with
Luer-lock Sampling Entrance

Figure 10-4: Straight Ventilation Adaptor Setup

Sampling Line
(Luer-lock)

15mm I.D./15mm O.D.


Elbow Adaptor with
Luer-lock Sampling Entrance

22mm I.D. Ventilation Tube


with 15mm I.D. Adaptor

Endotracheal Tube 15mm O.D.

Figure 10-5: Elbow Ventilation Adaptor Setup


Calibration and Startup

The monitor automatically begins an auto-calibration sequence when


powered up. During this time the monitor may display a flat
capnogram for approximately ten seconds. When the calibration and
warm up sequence is over the system messages disappear and
normal operation begins.

10 6

10 Anesthetic Agents

Procedure for Gas Monitoring

1. Check the Flow Rate settings in the PARAMS softkey window.


2. Slide the WaterChek water trap into the gas receptacle of the
monitor.
3. If anesthetic agents are being used, attach a scavenging line to
the exhaust port at the pedestal of the monitor. A waste gas
recovery system should be used.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

4. Attach a sample line to the Luer fixture located on the front of


the WaterChek water trap.
5. Make sure the sampling line is not kinked or pinched.
6. Attach a patient sampling device to the sampling line. Use either
a nasal cannula, mask or ventilation tube adapter.
7. Replace sampling devices, lines, and water traps if they become
blocked or filled.
Occlusions

The monitor displays a visual message AGT: OCCLUSION if the gas


sampling system is blocked. If the sampling line or water trap
becomes partially blocked, the item should be replaced.

Anesthetic Gas
Exhaust Recovery

Always use an exhaust gas recovery system when using anesthetic


gasses. A scavenging kit can be used to connect the monitor to a gas
scavenging system.
1. Slide the tube over the nozzle of the exhaust port located on the
back of the monitor base, near the DC power cord.
2. Connect female Luer-lock end to an exhaust recovery system.
A straight adaptor 19mm O.D./19mm I.D. with a male Luer-lock
entrance is provided with the scavenging kit to provide a connection
to scavenging tubing.
The monitor displays AGT: NO EXHAUST if the scavenging line is
blocked.

10 7

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

11 CO2, O2, and N2O


Theory of Operation
Respiration

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Capnometry
(Measurement of CO2)

Respiration is measured via the CO2 monitoring module and is only


available in Anesthesia models.
The Veris monitor measures CO2 concentrations and sends data
suitable for a continuous waveform display. The monitor also detects
end-tidal and fractional Inspired CO2 levels and displays the
numerical values. End-tidal CO2 (EtCO2) is defined as the maximum
CO2 concentration at the end of expiration. The monitor measures the
CO2 concentration and displays the numerical value. The EtCO2
value is updated continuously with each breath cycle. The amount of
CO2 in the gas mixture inhaled by the patient is the fractional Inspired
CO2 (FICO2).
The monitor measures CO2 using the principles of infrared absorption
spectrometry. An unknown concentration of gas (CO2) is calculated
by comparing its absorption of infrared light to that of a known
standard. The absorption of light is directly related to the
concentration of the gas. As infrared light passes through the sample
gas chamber, the light transmitted is converted to a voltage signal.
The monitor converts the voltage into CO2 concentration data that
can be expressed numerically or as waveforms. The Beer's Law
calculation is performed by the software of the Veris monitor.
Infrared analysis of the gas samples is done using Beers Law. The
formula for Beers Law is as follows:

I
I0
e
( )

I = I0 e ( )cd

Infrared value of measured sample.


Infrared value of light source.
Exponential function.
Extinction coefficient.

Concentration of the gas sample

Distance measured through the sample

CONDITIONS OF USE

The Veris monitor has been calibrated with dry NIST-traceable


calibration gases at room temperature and pressure (~ 21C, 740
mmHg). Given the small effect of water vapor on agent gas and CO2
measurements and the monitors built-in temperature and pressure
measurements and compensations, this method of gas analysis per
EN 864 is best described as ATPS (Ambient Temperature and
Pressure, Saturated; 21C, 750mmHg, 100% Humidity Saturated).

11 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The Veris monitor is suitable for sustained pressure (breathing circuit)


monitoring environments and has been tested per Clause 102
(Sustained Pressure) of EN 864.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

STABILITY OF ACCURACY

The monitor has an internal barometer and thermistor that allow


compensation for changes over a range of temperature and
atmospheric pressures. The monitor complies with EN 864 standards
for cyclical pressure. The module as installed in the Veris monitor has
been clinically tested for performance with a variety of patients.
Measuring Oxygen (O2)

The Veris monitor uses the sidestream method of measuring O2. The
gas is sampled from the same gas intake system used in CO2
monitoring. The water trap removes moisture and particulate matter
from the gas samples.
METHOD

The gas sample is measured using a reactive oxygen cell. The


oxygen sensor is a galvanic electrochemical cell that works by a
process known as oxidation reduction.
Oxygen from the air comes in contact with a highly reactive metal,
reacts with the metal and produces a current. As the oxygen reacts,
this reactive metal is gradually being used up. Once the metal is used
up, the cell is depleted and can no longer sense oxygen.
The cell generates a voltage output proportional to the amount of
oxygen in the sampled gas. This oxygen cell has an internal
thermistor and circuitry that adjusts the output voltage based on
current temperature of the cell.
The voltage is read by the microprocessor and an O2 measurement is
generated using predictive circuitry. This predictive function
enhances response time of the O2 monitoring module.
The relationship between gas concentration and pressure is
calculated by the microprocessor. The numerical value displayed by
the monitor (O2 Calculated) is generated using the following formula.
PC
20.9
O 2 Calculated = O 2 Measured ------------------------------ -----O 2Ambient P 0

The measured O2 predictive value is multiplied by a fixed value


derived from room pressure divided by room ambient oxygen levels.
The measurement is further adjusted by multiplying the ratio of the
pressure determined at calibration (PC) with the current pressure (P0).
There is a negligible effect on O2 measurements due to humidity.

11 2

11 CO2, O2, and N2O

CONDITIONS OF USE

The O2 function is appropriate for measuring respiratory O2


concentrations in all patient populations. The O2 monitor is suitable
for use in breathing systems and with the use of inhalation anesthetic
agents.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

STABILITY OF ACCURACY

The oxygen cell contains temperature correction circuitry. The oxygen


sensor temperature is maintained at a nominal 40 degrees Celsius to
maintain a consistent performance.

11 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CO2 Monitoring Procedure

Allow the CO2 monitor to warm up and auto-calibrate before use. It is


necessary to have the water trap sampling line attached so that the
monitor draws the correct air flow.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

When a patient is connected, the monitor begins displaying the endtidal and inspired CO2 values in the parameter box. The capnogram
waveform, if selected as a displayed waveform, provides a graphic
representation of the patients respiration cycle.
The source of the numeric respiration rate is determined through
capnography.
USE OF NITROUS OXIDE

Since nitrous oxide has a similar infrared signature to that of CO2,


and it affects absorption of CO2, special care must be taken when
measuring CO2 while anesthetics are being used.
INTERFERING GASSES FOR CO2

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The monitor will report small changes in CO2 when anesthetic agents
and oxygen are used. Expected CO2 changes are provided here for
the purpose of comparison.
For Gas mixtures of 5% CO2
Agent

Oxygen
N2O
Halothane
Enflurane
Isoflurane
Sevoflurane
Desflurane

Change of CO2

Agent Volume*

95%
89%
3%
5%
5%
5%
15%

-0.5%
+0.7% with N2O compensation
+0.2%
+0.4%
+0.4%
+0.4%
+0.5%

* Gas mixtures balanced with nitrogen.

11 4

11 CO2, O2, and N2O

O2 Monitoring Procedures

Interfering Gasses for O2

The monitor reports small changes in O2 when anesthetic agents and


oxygen are used. Expected O2 changes are provided here for the
purpose of comparison.
For Gas mixtures of O2

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.
This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

When a patient is connected, the monitor begins displaying the


expired and inspired O2 numerical values in the parameter box. All
procedures for patient setup, water traps, and occlusions apply to the
O2 measurement because the sample is taken from the same source.

Agents

Balance

Helium 50%
N2O 65%, CO2 5%
N2O 80%
Halothane 4%, N2O 66%
Enflurane 5%, N2O 65%
Isoflurane 5%, N2O 65%
Sevoflurane 5%, N2O 65%
Desflurane 15%, N2O 55%

Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen
Oxygen

Change of O2
50%
30%
20%
30%
30%
30%
30%
30%

+0.7%
+0.7%
+1.3%
+0.8%
+0.7%
+0.1%
-0.4%
-2.7%

N2O Monitoring
!

WARNING !

Environmental pollution of nitrous oxide and halogenated


agents may cause accuracy errors. Always use anesthetic gas
scavenging systems (AGSS) with the monitoring system.

11 5

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

12 Printing and Data Ports


Description

The optional remote display is equipped with a thermal dot-matrix


printer which is located on the top of the unit. The Veris remote
display is capable of printing all vital signs parameters in tabular (text)
format. The remote display can also produce graphical (waveform)
formats as specified by the user.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: The main monitor does not have an internal printer. Printing
can only be done if the system has a remote display.
Snapshot Size

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

History Size

The period of time (in a graphical print) that starts 4.5 seconds prior
to pressing the PRINT key and lasting the duration of the Snapshot
setting in the print menu (6, 12, 18, or 24 seconds). (i.e. if the print
type is set to graphical and snapshot is set to 6 seconds then the
Veris prints out the waveform data selected 4.5 seconds prior to a
PRINT keypress and 1.5 seconds after the PRINT keypress).
History Size is a period of time defined by the user that is prior to the
snapshot time period. History Size can be selected as 6 or 12
seconds.

Safety
!

WARNING !

Do not take the remote display into the MR Scanner room. The
remote display contains ferromagnetic material and can be
strongly attracted to the magnet causing a safety hazard.
NOTE: The remote display can only operate if the main monitor is
turned on. All audible and visual information displayed on the main
monitor is heard and seen on the remote unit in virtually real time. A
symbol displays in the upper right-hand corner of the screen to
indicate both devices are connected and active. The remote display
has access to all the same functions as the main monitor except for
the NIBP TEST and OPTION CONFIGURATION modes.

12 1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Print Modes
Demand Print

If the print type is set to tabular, pressing the PRINT key causes an
immediate print-out of the vital signs numbers, date, time and patient
data in a tabular text format.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

If the print type is set to graphical, pressing the PRINT key causes an
immediate print-out of the selected waveforms for a duration as
selected by snapshot size.
Continuous Print

If print type is set to Graphical, pressing and holding the PRINT key
for two seconds causes the selected waveforms to print out
continuously (until the PRINT key is pressed again) at 12.5mm/sec or
25mm/sec. If set to 50mm/sec, it defaults to 25mm/sec.

Alarm Print

The remote display issues a printout if a high, medium, or low alarm


occurs, as selected by the user in the PRINT softkey window. A new
alarm of equal or higher priority cancels a current printout and starts
a new printout.
If the Print Type is set to Tabular, a tabular demand print format is
issued if an alarm setting is violated.
If the Print Type is set to Graphical and Snapshot Size is set to 6
seconds, if an alarm setting is violated a graphical print strip is issued
displaying:
a 6 second snapshot,
plus history size,
the waveforms selected in the print menu.
This strip represents the history size added to the snapshot data.

BP Print

The remote display issues a printout at the completion of a successful


non-invasive blood pressure reading, as selected by the user in the
print menu.
If Print Type is set to Tabular, a tabular demand print format is issued
at the end of a successful non-invasive blood pressure reading. If
Print Type is set to Graphical and Snapshot Size is set to 6 seconds a
6 second graphical print strip is issued displaying the waveforms
selected in the print menu at the completion of a successful
noninvasive blood pressure reading.

Interval Print

Interval prints are periodic automatic printouts as selected by the


user in the Print menu. They are either Graphical or Tabular as
selected in the PRINT window.

12 2

12 Printing and Data Ports

Freeze Print

A freeze print is initiated by depressing the PRINT key after setting


the monitor in freeze mode (pressing the FREEZE key). The
printout is determined by the settings in the Print menu. This strip
represents the history size added to the snapshot data.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

If print type is set to Graphical, the waveforms selected are printed


out. The data printed is for a history time period followed by a
snapshot time period.
If Print Type is set to Tabular, a demand tabular print is issued using
the frozen numeric vital signs data on the screen.
Trend Print

After displaying a trend on the Veris screen (by pressing the TREND
key), press the PRINT key to print the trend data displayed on the
screen. If the monitor is set for Tabular trends, then the printout is
tabular; if the monitor is set for Graphical trends, then the printout is
graphical.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Press and hold the PRINT key (while a trend is displayed on the
monitor's screen) to print all of the stored Trend data.
If Serial is selected as the Print device (in the CONFIG menu) and the
user is in the Trend screen, the following occurs:
A short key press causes the serial port to output the trend
records the user is viewing;
A long key press causes the serial port to output the entire trend
records.

12 3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Print Formats

The internal thermal dot-matrix printer is capable of printing vital


signs parameters in tabular (text) or graphical (waveforms). Select the
printout format in the PRINT softkey menu.
Tabular Printing

A header is printed containing the monitor model, the operating


software revision, the time and date, and the patient information. The
title for each parameter follows.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Numerical values for all current parameters are printed. The sample
below shows a tabular print out.
MEDRAD Veris
07-10-04
NAME: SMITH
JOHN

Rev 4.2D
8:50:11
Q

ID:4680592421
Room number:101
07-10-04 8:50:11
HR
( ECG )
60
BPM
SpO2
98
%
RESP ( CO2 )
20
Br/m
TEMP
96.4
97.7 F
GAS EXP
INS
CO2
37
8
mmHg
O2
17
21
%
HAL
11.0*
10.5*%
N2O
39
64
%
ART1 145 /105*(125 )mmHg
CVP2
( 13 )mmHg

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure 12-1: Tabular Printout


Graphical Printing

If both waveform 1 and 2 have been set to a physical parameter the


print out will be a split dual waveform. If only one of the waveforms is
turned on, a single waveform will be printed using the entire
waveform area. If both waveforms are turned off, the waveform area
of the print out is blank.
Selectable options for waveforms are ECG I, II, III, V, aVR, aVL, aVF,
PLETH, IBP I, IBP II, Et CO2, O2, AGT, N2O, and OFF.
Numerical values for heart rate, SpO2, NIBP, temperature, respiration,
EtCO2, INCO2, EtO2, INO2, INS AGT, EXP AGT, INS N2O, and EXP
N2O are printed above and below the waveform grid.

12 4

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

12 Printing and Data Ports

Figure 12-2: Single Waveform Printout

Figure 12-3: Dual Waveform Printout

Figure 12-4: Sample Agent with CO2 Printout

12 5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Data in corner for


top waveform

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Data in corner for


bottom waveform

Figure 12-5: Sample ECG with Pleth Printout


The printout can be configured with a variety of waveform pairs. The
example above shows an ECG waveform and a plethysmographic
waveform. The top waveform information appears in the upper right
corner of the printout. The lower waveform information appears in the
lower right corner of the printout.
The example above is the shortest printed waveform view available.
Longer printouts can be configured in the PRINT menu.
An asterisk (*) after a parameter value represents when the system
alarmed for that parameter.

Figure 12-6: Alarms Noted with Asterisks

12 6

12 Printing and Data Ports

Changing Printer Paper

The monitor uses thermal paper. The paper must be loaded with the
thermal reactive side down as shown in the pictures below.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Open the printer door and remove the old spool.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure 12-7: Open The Printer Door


Insert the paper between the rollers.

Figure 12-8: Insert Paper

12 7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The paper automatically feeds when the paper is inserted.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

NOTE: If the paper does not automatically feed, check that the
PAPER RELEASE lever is in the horizontal position. If it is and the
paper does not automatically feed, check that there is no paper jam.
Use the MANUAL FEED knob if the printer still does not automatically
feed.
PAPER
MANUAL FEED
RELEASE lever
knob

Figure 12-9: Feed Paper


Close the paper door while sliding the end of the paper through the
slot in the door.

Figure 12-10: Close Door

12 8

12 Printing and Data Ports

Data Output Ports


!

WARNING !

Do not use the connectors on the back of the main monitor.


These connectors do not provide the required patient isolation.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The Veris monitor supports a variety of communication connections.


The communications ports are located along the left edge of the back
of the remote display. The ports are as follows:
COM1 Port, RS232 Serial DB-9
COM2 Port, MiniDIN 8, Service/Analog
NOTE: Any serial cables connected to the ports must be IEC 950 or
IEC 60950 compliant. Any peripherals connected to the monitoring
devices must be IEC 950 or IEC 60950 compliant.
COM1 Port

The monitor uses a serial port (DB-9 female) for the external data
output port and for loading system software updates. The monitor
uses a standard RS232 communication protocol with no flow control.
NOTE: This connection has a protective cover that needs to be
removed before use.

PINOUT CHART
Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9

1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
Pinout,
DB-9 connector

Signal
(Unused)
RX1
TX1
(Unused)
Ground
(Unused)
(Unused)
(Unused)
(Unused)

Figure 12-11: COM1 Pinout Diagram

12 9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

SERIAL PRINTING

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The COM 1 port supports sending data to an external serial printer or


computer terminal. To send the data as described in the beginning of
this section to the COM 1 port, the print device must be set to Serial
in the CONFIG menu. Printing is then routed to the COM1 port
instead of the internal printer.
Set the serial format to TEXT in the CONFIG menu to simulate the
tabular printout of the internal printer. Set the serial format to CSV in
the CONFIG menu to create a comma separated variable table. The
CSV format can be used by software programs. A description of the
CSV format is located at the end of this section.
SENDING DATA TO A COMPUTER

Use a serial download cable to connect to standard male DB-9


computer serial ports. A common computer terminal program and an
unused RS232 serial port is needed for external communications.
MEDRAD recommends using the Windows HYPERTRM.EXE
program provided with MS Windows 95 or later operating systems.
HYPERTRM.EXE can be found in the Windows accessory directory.
For older computers using MS Windows 3.1, the communications
program TERMINAL.EXE can be found in the Windows directory.
Set the monitor to interval printing with serial output selected. With
the computer terminal connected, a data file may be collected. The
file may then be further evaluated by computer. See the description
for CSV format at the end of this section.
TERMINAL CONFIGURATION

The cable connections should be completed and the terminal


program should be configured before attempting to send data.
The recommended settings
Baud Rate:
Parity:
Stop Bits:
Data Bits:
Hardware Control:

are as follows:
9600 or 19200
No Parity
1
8
None

EXTERNAL SERIAL PRINTER ACCESORY

The selected external printer must be configured so that it can


communicate with the monitor. Follow the configuration instructions
provided with your printer.
The required settings are as follows:
Baud Rate: 9600 or 19200
Parity:
No Parity
Stop Bits:
1
Data Bits:
8

12 10

12 Printing and Data Ports

COM2 Port

The monitor uses the COM2 serial port (8-pin Mini DIN) for loading
system software updates and for reprogramming the monitor. The
communications ability of this port is for service use only.
There is also an analog output signal available at pin 2. For
information about sending analog data to a plotter or chart recorder
contact MEDRAD Technical Support.
The connector pinouts are shown below.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

PINOUT CHART

Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

4
3

8
7
Pinout,
DIN8 connector

Signal
Boot 2
Analog Wave
RX 2
Ground
TXL
TX3
RX3
Boot 1

Figure 12-12: COM2 Port Pinout Diagram.


Video Port

The monitor provides a DB-15 VGA video port that is functional on


monitors with TFT screens.

12 11

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CSV Data Format

The Comma-Separated Variable output presents the data in a form


that is easily imported into a spreadsheet application where further
analysis can be done on the data. The data is output in ASCII format
with each field (time, heart rate, SpO2, IBP, CO2, O2, agent, N2O,
temperature, temperature type [degrees F or C], systolic, diastolic,
and map) separated with a comma. Using the Microsoft Windows
TERMINAL.EXE program and Microsoft Excel, here is an example
of how it may be used:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1. Connect the COM1 port to the serial port on the computer.


2. Start Terminal from the Accessories menu.
3. Choose Settings|Communications to set the computer's
connector to the proper port. Check communications settings.
4. Choose Transfers|Receive Text File. Assign a name to the data
(e.g. DATA.TXT) and press OK.
5. At this point, all data transmitted from the monitor will appear on
the screen and will be saved in DATA.TXT.
6. When all the desired data has been accumulated, choose
Transfers|Stop to close DATA.TXT.
7. Start EXCEL and choose File|Open.
8. Enter/Click on the file name and press the Text button.
9. For Column Delimiter, choose "Comma". For File Origin, choose
"Windows (ANSI)". Then choose OK.
10.Choose OK again from the Open dialog to open and display
DATA.TXT.
The data will be organized in a table by field. Using the EXCEL
presentation options, this data could be graphed, printed in tabular
form, or analyzed statistically in some other way.

12 12

Appendix A: Maintenance
This section contains recommended procedures for maintenance,
and an operational checkout of the Veris 8600 patient monitor.
Routine maintenance and inspection will:
Ensure continued performance of the patient monitor.
Reduce the possibility of equipment malfunction.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Cleaning and Disinfecting

WARNING !

Shock Hazard! Turn the power off and disconnect the AC power
cable before cleaning the monitor and sensors.
Shock Hazard! Never immerse the monitor in any liquid. The
monitor has an internal power source that is active when the
unit is unplugged.
Shock Hazard! Do not clean the main monitor or accessories
with the patient attached to the monitor.
Shock Hazard! Remove the power cord from the base of the
patient monitor to isolate any AC (Mains) power from the patient
monitor.
Shock Hazard! Remove the power cord from the remote display
to isolate any AC (Mains) power from the remote display.
Remove the main monitor from the MR Scanner room
environment to a safe location for cleaning purposes. Avoid
using cleaning products that are kept in ferromagnetic
containers.
Avoid using ferromagnetic tools in any maintenance procedure.
Improper disposal of batteries may result in explosion, leakage,
or personal injury. Do not open the batteries. Do not dispose of
the batteries in a fire. Follow all local and national regulations
concerning the disposal of spent Lead-acid and Lithium-Ion
batteries, or contact MEDRAD for assistance.
Any harsh cleaning agent that is not recommended in this
manual shall not be used. Damage to the system may occur
which could affect functionality.
!

CAUTION !

Do not use abrasive cleaners on the monitor or on any sensors


or probes. Abrasive cleaners can damage the monitor, sensors,
and probes.
The exterior surface of the monitor, except for the display
screen, may be wiped clean with alcohol and dried with a soft,
dry cloth. It is best to use a cotton cloth to clean the monitor.
Paper towels or tissues can scratch the surface of the display.

A-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

CAUTION !

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Do not use full strength alcohol on the display screen. Repeated


use of strong cleaners can damage the screen. Clean the
display window by wiping it with a clean, soft, lint-free cloth
sprayed with common glass cleaner. Do not spray glass cleaner
directly on the display.
Pulse Oximeter Sensors

CAUTION !

Do not immerse any MEDRAD pulse oximeter sensor connector


in any liquid. Doing so may damage the connector.
The SpO2 sensor may be wiped clean with alcohol. The SpO2 sensor
may be disinfected by placing the pads and cable in a 2%
glutaraldehyde solution. Place only the sensor paddles and cable in
the solution.
Blood Pressure Cuffs

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

The reusable blood pressure cuff may be cleaned by wiping it with a


damp cloth or sponge. If necessary, the cuff may be disinfected by
wiping with 70% alcohol, mild bleach solution, or other disinfectant.
Disposable blood pressure cuffs are for single patient use and are not
intended to be disinfected.
The cloth cuff and neoprene bag may be sterilized with commercially
available disinfectants such as ethylene oxide (EtO). Rinse
thoroughly to remove any residual disinfectants. Do not allow liquids
to enter the neoprene bag. The cloth cuff may also be sterilized in an
autoclave.
If the cuffs become grossly soiled with blood or other body fluids, the
cloth cuffs should be laundered by hand or machine. The dacron
cloth cuff may be laundered or sterilized by first removing the
neoprene inflation bag. Feed the inflation tube back through the hole
and then pull out the cloth flap.

Flap

Figure A-1: Remove Inflation Bag from Cuff


Roll up the inflation bag and slide it out the open slot in the cloth cuff.
Be sure to observe the following laundering precautions (disposable
cuffs and neoprene inserts should not be laundered).

A-2

Appendix A:Maintenance

Remove the inflatable bag from the cuff before laundering or


sterilizing the cuff.
Strong bleach solutions will damage the cuff.
Temperatures over 275 F (135 C) will damage the cuff.
Close the Velcro fastener before laundering the cuff.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Soaking the cuff in dark-colored solutions may stain or discolor


the cuff.
Hand laundering (as opposed to machine laundering) prolongs the
life of the cuff. Wash the cuff in warm, soapy water. Rinse the cuff
thoroughly. After cleaning the cuff, allow the cuff to air dry, then insert
the inflation bag in the cuff.
Temperature

The temperature cable and probe may be wiped clean with alcohol.
The temperature cable and probe may be disinfected by wiping the
cable and probe in a 2% glutaraldehyde solution. Do not place either
the cable nor the probe in the solution.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

TEMPERATURE PROBE

Clean the probe according to the hospital protocol for cleaning of


reusable equipment cables and probes. Typically this protocol
consists of the following:
1. Disconnect the cable from the monitor and temperature sensor
(probe).
2. Wipe the probe with a nonabrasive cloth moistened with a mild
detergent and warm water or disinfectant. Dry thoroughly.
3. Do not use solvents to clean the probe.
4. Do not allow the probe connectors and contact points to come in
contact with liquids.
5. Do not fully immerse the probe in liquids.
6. Do not autoclave or EtO sterilize the probe.

A-3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Accidental Wetting

WARNING !

Shock Hazard! The monitor is an AC powered device and an


immersed monitor presents a danger to anyone who handles
the device.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

The action to be taken following accidental wetting of the equipment


is as follows:
1. Turn the power off! Disconnect the AC power cord from the
monitor, remote display, or power supply.
2. If monitoring a patient, transfer the patient to another monitor as
quickly as possible.
3. Use a clean, dry towel or cloth to remove the liquid from the
housing.
4. The monitor, remote display, or power supply should be
inspected by a service technician as soon as possible.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

5. If the internal mechanism is saturated, allow the liquid to drain


out for 24 hours before shipping.
6. If liquid has entered the monitor, remote display, or power
supply, it needs to be dried and cleaned internally. Full testing is
required before the monitor, remote display, or power supply
can be used. Contact the MEDRAD Service Department as
soon as possible.
Time is critical! The longer any liquid remains in the monitor, remote
display, or power supply, the more damage it can do. It is important to
service the monitor, remote display, or power supply immediately
after any liquid is spilled into it.

A-4

Appendix A:Maintenance

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Annual Safety Tests

The monitor and remote display should be electrically tested


annually. The safety tests should be performed only by experienced
service technicians. Refer to the Veris 8600 Service Manual for
additional information.

System Testing

The monitor has built-in system tests which should be performed


regularly. However, the tests should be performed by qualified service
personnel only.

Service Checks

If the monitor shows any signs of physical damage, contact MEDRAD


Service immediately.
Have a qualified service technician perform the following
performance and safety checks annually.
Perform complete functional testing of the monitor.
Test the monitor for electrical leakage and withstanding voltage.
Do not remove the cover. Refer all servicing to a qualified technician.
Descriptions of these tests can be found in the Veris 8600 Service
Manual. Some tests may require specialized equipment.

CAUTION !

The accuracy of the NIBP measurement is directly related to the


accuracy of the calibration of the internal pressure tranducer in
the NIBP electronics. This transducer is calibrated by manually
adjusted electro-mechanical potentiometers internal to the
monitor. To ensure continued NIBP accuracy, the Maintenance
Schedule defined in this appendix must be performed as
specified.

A-5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Maintenance Schedule

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Every Patient

Every Day

Every Week

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Every 3 Months

Every Year

Your Veris 8600 patient monitor must be properly maintained to


ensure that it is in peak operating condition. Your individual
maintenance system and schedule depends upon how your monitor
is used, the type of procedures performed, and frequency of use. The
following maintenance schedule is recommended for the system:

Clean and disinfect the sensor cables and sensor.


Inspect the accessories and cables for damage.
Change the gas sampling device and sampling line.
Check the NIBP function.
Change the water trap

Charge the batteries as necessary. If not using the monitor on a


patient, keep it plugged into the power supply for continuous
charging.
Test the NIBP function.
Charge the ECG module battery.
Compare temperature function with another temperature source.
Clean the exterior of the unit (or clean as needed).
Fully charge the batteries.
Check the O2 cell. Change if necessary.
Perform the annual safety tests described in the service manual.
Perform NIBP calibration and safety test
Verify the CO2 and agent gas auto-calibration. Calibrate if
necessary.
Change the O2 cell.
Check the CO2 absorber. Change if necessary
Check the gas flow rate. Adjust if necessary.

MEDRAD also recommends that a complete system calibration and


performance checkout be performed annually. Contact MEDRAD
Factory Service, or your local MEDRAD office for complete details.
In the United States, Canada, and Europe, the MEDRAD Service
Department offers Preventive Maintenance Programs. These annual
programs greatly assist in maintaining accuracy and reliability, and
can also extend the life of the system. Contact MEDRAD for details,
In Europe, contact your local MEDRAD office or your local authorized
dealer for further information. Refer to In Case of Emergency
Contact on page xi.

A-6

Appendix A:Maintenance

NOTES: If not using the monitor on a patient, keep it plugged into the
power supply for continuous charging.
Failures which occur due to lack of proper maintenance will not be
covered under warranty.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Local regulations or hospital protocol may require electrical leakage


checks at more frequent intervals. If this applies, local regulations for
leakage must be followed.
Long-Term Storage

Before long-term storage, the lead-acid batteries in the monitor must


be fully charged. To ensure battery performance, recharge the
batteries every 30 days. See Environmental on page C-7 for storage
environmental conditions.
Disposal

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

No special preparation is necessary for long term storage of the


monitor. To prolong battery life, batteries should be stored in a
charged state and periodically refreshed to prevent damage.

At the end of its useful life, the monitor and its accessories may be
disposed of according to your institution's policies and procedures
and any local and national policies and procedures for disposal of
patient-contact medical waste. Discard disposable medical waste
according to your institution's policies and procedures to prevent
biological contamination.
Improper disposal of batteries may result in explosion, leakage, or
personal injury. Do not open batteries. Do not dispose of batteries in
a fire. Follow all local regulations concerning the disposal of spent
Lead-acid and Lithium-Ion batteries or contact MEDRAD for
assistance.
Alternately, the monitor and its accessories may be returned to
MEDRAD, Inc., for safe disposal. The shipping address is:
MEDRAD, Inc.
One Medrad Drive
Indianola, PA 15051-0780

A-7

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Appendix B: Unit and


Configuration
Defaults
VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Restoring the Unit Default


Profile

A set of unit defaults are pre loaded into the non-volatile memory of
the monitor. These defaults can be used as they exist, or can be used
as the basis for creating your own default profile.
The unit default profile can be modified or renamed or replaced if
desired. If you modify the unit defaults it is recommended that you
rename them.
1. Press the DEFAULT button. The Restore Unit Defaults menu
appears. The SELECT option and the currently active profile are
both highlighted.
2. Press the menu knob to scroll through the choices.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

3. Turn the knob to ACCEPT.


4. Press the menu knob once. The message Action Completed is
highlighted.
5. Press the menu knob to re-establish the profile. The monitor
returns to the main menu.
Default Settings
Unit Default Settings

Customized defaults can be saved for use at a later time. Starting


from the monitors main screen, do the following:
1. Set specific defaults for parameters and alarms. These are set
through the ALARMS, PARAMS, DISPLAY, CONFIG, and
PRINT softkeys.
2. Press and hold the DEFAULT button located on the front panel.
The Set Unit Defaults dialog box appears.
NOTE: If the Set Unit Defaults dialog box that prompts you to
enter a password did not appear, you did not hold the button in
properly. In this case, turn the knob to highlight and select
CANCEL, or you could lose the settings just created.

B-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

3. Enter the password MEDRAD (required to save the customized


default):
Turn the menu knob to highlight a single letter or number.
Press the menu knob to select that letter or number.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Continue for each letter and number of the password.


After pressing the menu knob for the last figure of the
password, the monitor indicates acceptance of the password
by displaying the Set Unit Defaults window.
4. When the Set Unit Defaults window displays, both SELECT and
CUSTOM DEFAULTS are highlighted.
Set Unit Defaults
Replace all configuration
and alarm settings with
unit default settings.
SELECT
EDIT
ACCEPT

CUSTOM DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS

CANCEL

Figure B-1: Set Unit Defaults Screen


NOTE: Selecting a value in Set Unit Defaults window is different than
other windows. At this point in this procedure, the right column of this
window is active.
5. With both SELECT and CUSTOM DEFAULTS highlighted in the
Set Unit Defaults window, press the menu knob to scroll the
highlight bar down the right-hand column list to the desired
default to be changed. Press to select.
6. Turn the menu knob to scroll the highlight bar to EDIT. Press to
select. The selected default remains highlighted as the menu
knob is rotated. The first letter of the selected default is
highlighted when the menu knob is pressed.
7. Change the label to the new default name by turning the menu
knob to select the first letter in the new name for the default.
Press to select. The next letter is automatically highlighted.
Continue for the remaining letters of the new default name.
8. After completing the last letter of the new name, press the menu
knob until the entire label name is highlighted. This indicates
that entry is complete, but not accepted.

B-2

Appendix B:Unit and Configuration Defaults

9. To accept the new label name, turn the menu knob to highlight
ACCEPT and press to select. The message Action Completed
appears.
Set Unit Defaults

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Set current configuration


and alarm settings as new
unit default settings.
SELECT
EDIT
ACCEPT

CUSTOM DEFAULTS
NEW DEFAULT
STD DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS
STD DEFAULTS

CANCEL

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Figure B-2: Set Units Defaults After Modifications


10.Press the menu knob. Your new default set of is saved in
memory.
11.Press the ON/OFF button, located on the front panel, to turn off
the monitor.
Configuration Default Settings

1. From the Set Unit Defaults screen, press and hold the DEFAULT
key again. The Install Configuration Defaults screen displays.
(See Figure B-3: Install Configuration Defaults Screen).
Install Configuration Defaults
Replace the current set of
configuration defaults with
a different set of defaults.
SELECT
ACCEPT

Base System
Cardiac System
Anesthesia System

CANCEL

Figure B-3: Install Configuration Defaults Screen


The Install Configuration Defaults screen permits choosing which set
of 3 defaults are available to the user.

B-3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The selection procedure works the same as in the previous screens.


1. WIth the SELECT feature highlighted, press the menu knob to
select from Base System, Cardiac System or Anesthesia
System (depending upon your units configuration).

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Turn the menu knob to select ACCEPT. The message Action


Completed appears. Press the menu knob to effect the change.

B-4

Appendix B:Unit and Configuration Defaults

Configuration Settings for Unit


Defaults

The configuration settings for the three configuration setup defaults


are the same as the basic hospital configuration settings except for
the following, grouped by menu:

PARAMS Menu Settings

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

Cardiac
with Temp

Anesthesia

Anesthesia
with Temp

CO2

ON

ON

O2

ON

ON

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Setting
Audible Tone
Volume

HR Source

Smart

Smart

Gating
ECG

ON

ON

Smart

Smart

Smart

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

ON

ON

ON

ON

ECG Cable

3 lead

3 lead

5 lead

5 lead

5 lead

5 lead

ECG Filter

Monitor

Monitor

Monitor

Monitor

Monitor

Monitor

NO

NO

YES

YES

YES

YES

ART

ART

ART

ART

0 to 200

0 to 200

0 to 200

0 to 200

None

None

None

None

Auto Lead Switching


IBP1 Site

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Smart

IBP 1 Range
IBP 1 Zero
IBP2 Site

IBP 2 Range

CVP

CVP

CVP

CVP

0 to 20

0 to 20

0 to 20

0 to 20

None

None

None

None

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

NIBP Tone

None

None

None

None

None

None

NIBP Cycle Time

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

SpO2

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

SpO2 Average

12

12

12

12

12

12

IBP 2 Zero
NIBP

SpO2 Search Time


SpO2 Low Limit Alarm

20

20

20

20

20

20

High

High

High

High

High

High

Respiration

ON

ON

Respiration source

CO2

CO2

Temp1

ON

ON

Temp2

ON

ON

Unit of Measure

CO2 Unit of
Measure
Agent to Monitor
(Primary)

mmHg

mmHg

Automatic

Automatic

Gas Flow Rate

200 ml

200 ml

Flow Mode

Exhaust

Exhaust

B-5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

PRINT Menu Settings

BasePlus

na

Graphical

na

Graphical

na

Graphical

Alarm Print

na

OFF

na

OFF

na

OFF

BP Print

na

Off

na

Off

na

Off

Interval Print

na

Off

na

Off

na

Off

Interval Print Type

na

Tabular

na

Tabular

na

Tabular

Snapshot Size

na

6 seconds

na

6 seconds

na

6 seconds

History Size

na

6 seconds

na

6 seconds

na

6 seconds

Waveform 1

na

ECG II

na

ECG II

na

ECG II

Gain (waveform 1)

na

x1.0

na

x1.0

na

x1.0

Waveform 2

na

PLETH

na

PLETH

na

PLETH

Gain (waveform 2)

na

x1.0

na

x1.0

na

x1.0

Printer Speed

na

25.0 mm/sec

na

25.0 mm/sec

na

25.0 mm/sec

Print Type
(Demand)
VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Anesthesia; Anesthesia;
Anesthesia Anesthesia
w/Temp
w/Temp
w/o Remote w/o Remote
Display
Display

Base

Setting

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Cardiac;
Cardiac
w/Temp
w/Remote
Display

Cardiac;
Cardiac
w/Temp
w/o Remote
Display

* Available as an option if the system has a remote display


DISPLAY Menu Settings

Setting

All Cardiac and


Anesthesia Units

Base/BasePlus

Waveform 1

ECG II,x1,25,25

ECG II,x1,25,25

Waveform 2

OFF

OFF

Waveform 3

ECG I,x1,25,25

ECG I,x1,25,25

Waveform 4

PLETH,x1,25,25

PLETH,x1,25,25

Waveform 5

OFF

aVL

Waveform 6

OFF

aVR

B-6

Appendix B:Unit and Configuration Defaults

ALARMS Menu Settings

Setting

Cardiac
Anesthesia
with Temp Anesthesia with Temp

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

Adult, Pediatric

150

150

150

150

150

150

Neonate

180

180

180

180

180

180

Heart Rate (High)

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Heart Rate (Low)


Adult, Pediatric

40

40

40

40

40

40

Neonate

90

90

90

90

90

90

SpO2 (High)

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

SpO2 (Low)

90

90

90

90

90

90

Adult, Pediatric

200

200

200

200

200

200

Neonate

140

140

140

140

140

140

Adult, Pediatric

50

50

50

50

50

50

Neonate

35

35

35

35

35

35

100

100

100

100

100

100

80

80

80

80

80

80

Adult, Pediatric

30

30

30

30

30

30

Neonate

30

30

30

30

30

30

Adult, Pediatric

150

150

150

150

150

150

Neonate

100

100

100

100

100

100

Adult, Pediatric

50

50

50

50

50

50

Neonate

35

35

35

35

35

35

Temperature 1/2
(High)

na

na

na

100

na

100

Temperature1/ 2 (Low)

na

na

na

93

na

93

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

na

na

36

36

Neonate

na

na

na

na

60

60

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

na

na

Neonate

NIBP Systolic (High)

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

NIBP Systolic (Low)

NIBP Diastolic (High)


Adult, Pediatric
Neonate
NIBP Diastolic (Low)

NIBP Mean (High)

NIBP Mean (Low)

Respiration (High)

Respiration (Low)
na

na

na

na

14

14

CO2 Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

10

10

CO2 Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

CO2 Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

55

55

CO2 Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

20

20

B-7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Setting

Cardiac
Anesthesia
with Temp Anesthesia with Temp

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

O2 Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

100

100

O2 Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

18

18

O2 Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

100

100

O2 Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

IBP1 Systolic (High)


Adult, Pediatric

na

na

200

200

200

200

Neonate

na

na

140

140

140

140

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

50

50

50

50

Neonate

na

na

50

50

50

50

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

100

100

100

100

Neonate

na

na

80

80

80

80

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

30

30

30

30

Neonate

na

na

30

30

30

30

IBP1 Systolic (Low)

IBP1 Diastolic (High)

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

IBP1 Diastolic (Low)

IBP1 Mean (High)


Adult, Pediatric

na

na

150

150

150

150

Neonate

na

na

100

100

100

100

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

50

50

50

50

Neonate

na

na

40

40

40

40

IBP2 Mean (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

IBP2 Mean (Low)

na

na

IBP1 Mean (Low)

ART Systolic (High)


Adult, Pediatric

na

na

200

200

200

200

Neonate

na

na

140

140

140

140

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

50

50

50

50

Neonate

na

na

50

50

50

50

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

100

100

100

100

Neonate

na

na

80

80

80

80

Adult, Pediatric

na

na

30

30

30

30

Neonate

na

na

30

30

30

30

ART Systolic (Low)

ART Diastolic (High)

ART Diastolic (Low)

ART Mean (High)


Adult, Pediatric

na

na

150

150

150

150

Neonate

na

na

100

100

100

100

B-8

Appendix B:Unit and Configuration Defaults

Setting

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

na

na

50

Cardiac
Anesthesia
with Temp Anesthesia with Temp

ART Mean (Low)


Adult, Pediatric

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Neonate

50

50

50

na

na

40

40

40

40

PA Systolic (High)

na

na

40

40

40

40

PA Systolic (Low)

na

na

15

15

15

15

PA Diastolic (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

PA Diastolic (Low)

na

na

PA Mean (High)

na

na

20

20

20

20

PA Mean (Low)

na

na

10

10

10

10

LA Mean (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

LA Mean (Low)

na

na

LV Systolic (High)
Adult

na

na

200

200

200

200

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

60

60

60

60

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

40

40

40

40

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

120

120

120

120

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

60

60

60

60

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

RA Mean (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

RA Mean (Low)

na

na

Adult

na

na

50

50

50

50

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

20

20

20

20

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

20

20

20

20

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

LV Systolic (Low)

LV Diastolic (High)

LV Diastolic (Low)

LV Mean (High)

LV Mean (Low)

RV Systolic (High)

RV Systolic (Low)

RV Diastolic (High)

B-9

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Setting

Cardiac
Anesthesia
with Temp Anesthesia with Temp

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

Adult

na

na

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

30

30

30

30

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

Adult

na

na

10

10

10

10

Pediatric, Neonate

na

na

CVP Mean (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

CVP Mean (Low)

na

na

ICP Mean (High)

na

na

15

15

15

15

ICP Mean (Low)

na

na

Primary Inspired
(High)

na

na

na

na

2.3

Primary Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

Primary Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

1.5

1.5

Primary Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

RV Diastolic (Low)

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

RV Mean (High)

RV Mean (Low)

2.3

N2O Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

75

75

N2O Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

N2O Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

N2O Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

HAL Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

2.3

2.3

HAL Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

HAL Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

1.5

1.5

HAL Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

ENF Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

4.8

4.8

ENF Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

ENF Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

3.2

3.2

ENF Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

ISO Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

3.6

3.6

ISO Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

ISO Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

2.4

2.4

ISO Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

DES Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

18.0

18.0

DES Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

DES Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

12.0

12.0

DES Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

SEV Inspired (High)

na

na

na

na

5.1

5.1

SEV Inspired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

B-10

Appendix B:Unit and Configuration Defaults

Setting

Cardiac
Anesthesia
with Temp Anesthesia with Temp

Base

BasePlus

Cardiac

SEV Expired (High)

na

na

na

na

3.4

3.4

SEV Expired (Low)

na

na

na

na

OFF

OFF

Other Alarm Settings

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

All models

Value

Alarm Volume

Apnea

20 seconds

ECG Lead Fail

Medium

B-11

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Appendix C: Specifications
ECG
ECG System

Lead Selection:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Frequency Response:
Safety Standards:

EMC Standards:
ECG Module

Dimensions:
Lead Connectors:
Lead Connector Color Code:
Patient Isolation:
Defibrillation Protection:
Electrosurgery Protection:
HF Equipment Protection:
Pacemaker Pulse Rejection:
Battery:
Battery Life:
Low Battery Indication:
Protection Against Water Ingress:
MR Environment Safety:

Leadset

Description:
Configurations:

Lead Color Code:


ECG Module Fiber Optic Cable
Minimum Bend Radius:
MR Environment Safety:

3-Lead; I, II, III


5-Lead; I, II, III, aVR, aVL, aVF, V
Monitor; 1-40Hz (-3dB)
UL60601-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 601.1-M90
IEC 60601-1, IEC 60601-2-27
IEC 60601-1-2 2nd Edition, CISPR11 Class B
13.34cm. x 9.14 cm. x 3.10cm.
(5.25 in. x 3.60 in. x 1.22 in.)
3 or 5 Lead, Standard AAMI (DIN 42-802)
American Heart Association (AHA)
Type CF
Yes
No
No
No
Rechargeable 7.4V, 1.5Ah Lithium-Polymer,
internal, not user-serviceable, see Disposal
on page A-7 for disposal instructions
Approximately 40 hours of continuous use
Indication provided at approximately 7 hours
of continuous use remaining
IPX1
MR Safe
MR-Compatible, Radio Translucent, 14in
(35.6 cm)
3-Lead: RA (White); LA (Black); LL (Red)
5-Lead: RA (White); LA (Black); LL (Red);
V (Brown); RL (Green)
AHA
4 cm (1.6 inches)
MR Safe

C-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

ECG Module Charger

Dimensions:
AC Input:
AC Input Connection:
Output:
Charge Time:
Classification:
MR Environment Safety:
Charge Status Indicator
(Green LED):

Heart Rate

Source:
Range:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Accuracy:

Pulse Tone:
NIBP

Technique:
Measurement Time:
Automatic Measurement Cycles:
Measurable Pressure Range:
Resolution:
Transducer Accuracy:
STAT mode:

SpO2

Range:
Resolution:
Accuracy:
Averaging Time:
Search Time:
Indications
Method:
Modes:
Operation:
Sensor Wavelength:
Sensor Power:
SpO2 Sensor Cable
Minimum Bend Radius:

12.0cm. x 5.3cm. x 3.8cm.


(4.73 in. x 2.1 in. x 1.5 in.)
100-250VAC, 50/60Hz
Universal IEC inlet; use supplied cord
600mA at 7.4VDC
Less than 3 hours
Class II Medical Power Supply
NOT safe for use in Magnet Room
No Battery; Off
Charge Pending; Blip (10% ON)
Rapid Charge; Flash (50%)
Charge Complete; On
Charge Failure; Blip
Smart Switching;
ECG (primary), IBP, Pleth, NIBP
20-300 bpm (ECG, IBP, Pleth)
30-240 bpm (NIBP)
The greater of 1 bpm or 1% (ECG, NIBP,
Pleth)
The greater of 1 bpm or 1% (IBP for <30
bpm unspecified)
Selectable, On/Off
Oscillometric measure upon inflation
<40 seconds average; standard adult cuff
2, 3, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60 min; 2, 4 hrs
Adult; 30 to 300 mmHg
Pediatric; 30 to 300 mmHg
Neonatal; 20 to 150 mmHg
1 mmHg
The greater of 2 mmHg or 2% of reading
5 min of consecutive readings
1-99%.
1 percent of full scale
2 percent of full scale at 70 99%;
3 percent of full scale at 50 69%.
< 50% oxygen saturation is unspecified.
User selectable:
3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18, and 21 seconds.
User selectable: 10, 20, 30, and 40 seconds.
Plethysmographic waveform, Numeric
display.
Dual wavelength LED, Fiber Optic
Adult/Pediatric/Neonate
Continuous Use
660nm/905nm
<80mW
5.1 cm (2.0 inches)

C-2

Appendix C:Specifications

Invasive Blood Pressure

Channels:
Transducer Sites:

Defibrillation Protection:

2
Selectable:
ART, PA, RV, LV (Sys./Dia/MAP)
LA, RA, CVP, ICP (Mean)
-10mmHg to 300mmHg (increments of
1mmHg)
150 mmHg
5V/V/mmHg
1 mmHg
5 volts 0.1 volt
1 mmHg or 1%, whichever is greater
-10 to 10, 0 to 20, 0 to 30, 0 to 40, 0 to 60,
0 to 100, 0 to 150, 0 to 200, 0 to 300,
and Automatic
Yes

Frequency Response:
Transducer Impedance:
Transducer Sensitivity:
Pressure Range:

20 Hz
> 300 ohms
5 micro volts per volt per mmHg
-20 mmHg to 300 mmHg

Pressure Range:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Zero Offset:
Transducer Sensitivity:
Resolution:
Excitation Voltage:
Accuracy:
Scale Range:

Transducer

Gating

Signal Source:
Pulse output:
Waveform output:
Gating Signal Delay:
Visual Indication:
Function:

Temperature

Channels:
Technique:
Range:
Accuracy:

Sensor Type:
Temperature Sensor and
Connecting Cable
Minimum Bend Radius:

ECG, SpO2
50msec (10%) pulse width, synchronous
with the r-wave or corresponding peak of the
plethysmogram waveform.
One of the following, 1.5mV (0.5mv) ECG or
plethysmogram waveform.
<10 milliseconds (ECG), <20 milliseconds
(SpO2)
Icon at the upper right corner of the display
(ECG parameter box).
User selectable: Off, ECG Waveform or
Pulse, SpO2 Waveform or Pulse.
The gating function provides gating signals
97% of the time or greater after the first 2
pulses of a scanner RF sequence.
2
Fluoroptic Thermometer
20C to 45C (68F to 113F)
20 34.9C (68 94.9F, 0.544%)
35 41.9C (95 107.5F, 0.244%)
42 45C (107.6 113F, 0.544%)
Reusable, Fiber Optic Surface Probe.
7.6 cm (3.0 inches)

C-3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Halogenated Agents

Method:
Units:
Resolution:
Range:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Accuracy:
Identification Threshold:

Mixed Gas Threshold:


Primary Agent Identification:
Mixed Agent Identification:
Maximum Rise Time:

Maximum System Response Time:

Warm-up Time:
Calibration:
Auto Zeroing:
Display:
Effect of Interfering Gases:

Sidestream; non-dispersive infrared


Volume Percent
0.1 Volume Percent
Halothane; 0 to 10.0 vol. %
Isoflurane; 0 to 10.0 vol. %
Enflurane; 0 to 10.0 vol. %
Desflurane; 0 to 20.0 vol. %
Sevoflurane; 0 to 10.0 vol. %
(0.1% abs. + 4% of reading) for breath
rates up to 60 bpm.
Halothane; 0.2 vol. %
Isoflurane; 0.3 vol. %
Enflurane; 0.3 vol. %
Desflurane; 0.3 vol. %
Sevoflurane; 0.3 vol. %
0.2 vol. % + 10% of total concentration for
breath rates up to 60 bpm.
User Selectable or Automatic
Automatic (secondary agent)
With a concentration of 10% of the
halogenated agent, 10-90% of maximum,
using 16 foot sample line:
650 msec. for (10-90%) at 100 ml/min
500 msec. for (10-90%) at 150 ml/min
400 msec. for (10-90%) at 200 ml/min
(Using 16 foot sample line):
7.5 seconds (100 ml/min)
5.5 seconds (150 ml/min)
4.5 seconds (200 ml/min)
1 minute to first waveforms
< 20 minutes to full accuracy
Auto-calibrating
Occurs 30 to 60 minutes
Duration 3.0 to 7.0 seconds
Primary agent inspired and expired numerical
values, Primary agent waveform, Secondary
(mixed) agent numerical values
Ethyl alcohol: Negligible
Metabolic ketones, Acetone: Negligible
Carbon dioxide: Negligible
Nitrous oxide: Negligible
Helium: Negligible
Ether: Contraindicated
Cyclopropane: Contraindicated
Methoxyflurane: Contraindicated

C-4

Appendix C:Specifications

Capnometry (CO2)

Method:
Range:
Resolution:
Accuracy:

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Maximum Rise Time:

Response Time:

Calibration:
Units:
Display:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

CO2 Respiration

Oxygen Monitoring (O2)

Source:
Range:
Resolution:
Accuracy:
Units:
Display:
Method:
Range:
Resolution:
Accuracy:
Maximum Rise Time:

Maximum System Response Time:

Sidestream; non-dispersive infrared (NDIR)


0-99 mmHg, 0-12.5%, 0-12.5 kPa, 0-99 Torr
1 mmHg, 0.1%, 0.1 kPa, 1 Torr
0.2% abs. or 4% of reading for a range of 0
to 60 breaths per minute
With a concentration of 10% CO2, 10-90% of
maximum, using 16 foot sample line:
350 milliseconds at 100 ml/min
300 milliseconds at 150 ml/min
250 milliseconds at 200 ml/min
(Using 16 foot sample line):
7.0 seconds (100 ml/min)
5.0 seconds (150 ml/min)
4.0 seconds (200 ml/min)
Auto-calibrating
mmHg; Volume Percent; kPa; Torr
Inspired CO2, Expired CO2 (End-Tidal)
Numerical values, capnograph, and breath by
breath ETCO2 bar graph.
Capnogram
1 to 100 breaths/minute
1 breath/minute
The greater of 2 breaths/minute or 2% of
reading
Percent
Inspired O2, expired O2
Numerical values, waveform
Oxidation-reduction galvanic cell
0-100%
1%
3 vol. % (0 - 90%)
4 vol. % (91- 100%)
With a concentration of 80% O2, 0-90% of
maximum, using 16 foot sample line:
700 milliseconds at 100 ml/min
550 milliseconds at 150 ml/min
500 milliseconds at 200 ml/min
(Using 16 foot sample line):
8.0 seconds (100 ml/min)
5.5 seconds (150 ml/min)
4.5 seconds (200 ml/min)

C-5

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Nitrous Oxide (N2O)

Method:
Range:
Resolution:
Accuracy:

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Identification Threshold:
Maximum Rise Time:

Maximum System Response Time:

Calibration:
Units:
Display:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Pneumatics

Alarms

Flow rate:
Occlusion Clearing:
Filters:
Sample Lines:
Pneumatic Sound Pressure:
Characteristics:
Indication:
Levels:
Settings:
Alarm Modes:
Volume:
Silence:

Trend Reports

Printer (Remote Display only)

Types:
Trend memory:
Tabular Intervals:
Graphical Span:
Data Types:

Recorder Type:
Data Formats:
Paper Speed:

Sidestream; non-dispersive infrared (NDIR)


0 to 99 volume percent
1%
(1.5% abs. + 4% of reading) for breath
rates up to 60 bpm.
5% (for single and mixed agents)
With a concentration of 100% N2O, 10-90%
of maximum, using 16 foot sample line:
(10-90%) 400 milliseconds at 100 ml/min
(10-90%) 300 milliseconds at 150 ml/min
(10-90%) 250 milliseconds at 200 ml/min
(Using 16 foot sample line):
7.0 seconds (100 ml/min)
5.0 seconds (150 ml/min)
4.0 seconds (200 ml/min)
Auto-calibrating
Percent
Numerical Inspired N2O, Expired N2O; N2O
waveform
100, 150, 200 ml/min, User Selectable
Automatic
WaterChek 2+
16 foot
45 dBa maximum @ 1 meter
EN 475, Adjustable
Audible; Visual
High, Medium, Low, Informational,
Medium Quiet, Informational Quiet
User Defaults, Hospital Defaults,
Factory Defaults
Adult/Pediatric/Neonate,
High and low limit settings for each mode.
User Adjustable (1-10)
Yes; 2 minutes or permanent
Tabular and Graphical
24 hours (with NIBP every 3 minutes)
30 sec., 1, 2, 5,10, 30 min., 1, 2, 4 hrs.
2, 4, 8, 12, or 24 hours
HR, SpO2, Temp., Resp., EtCO2,
INCO2, Expired O2, Inspired O2,
NIBP (Systolic, Diastolic, Mean)
IBP (Systolic, Diastolic, Mean)
Agents, N2O
Internal thermal line printer
Single or dual waveform; Tabular
12.5 or 25mm/sec continuous.
(Snapshot at 50mm/sec)

C-6

Appendix C:Specifications

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Controls

System Outputs (Remote


Display Only)

Screen:
Resolution:
Waveforms:
Waveform Display Gain:
Waveform Sweep Speed:
Display Update Period:
Keys:
Rotary knob:
Languages:

10.4" active color TFT


640 x 480 pixels
6, maximum
.5, 1, 2, 4 user selectable
6.25, 12.5, 25 or 50 mm/sec, selectable
1.0 second
9; membrane-activated
Push and rotate; 24 steps/turn
English, French, German, Italian,
Portuguese, Spanish, Japanese

Comm Ports:

RS 232-compatible, digital DB9 (COM 1);


mini-DIN8 (COM 2)
mini-DIN8, Selectable waveform output,
Range: -2 to 3 volts,
Any Waveform (1 volt signal);
Plethysmograph or Capnogram
Serial VGA Compatible

Analog Output:

Video Port:
Main-Remote Communications
Cable Minimum Bend Radius:
Environmental

11.3 cm (4.5 inches)

Operating Temperature:
Storage Temperature:
Operating and Storage Humidity:
Operating atmospheric pressure:
Non-operating atmospheric pressure:
Type of Protection:
Degree of Protection:
Compatible scanners:
Protection against ingress:

15 to 35C (59 to 95F)


-5 to 50C (23 to 122F)
15% to 90%; non-condensing
69 and 110 kPa
48 and 110 kPa
Class I Equipment
Type CF, Defibrillator-Proof
0.5T, 1.0T, 1.5T, and 3.0T static magnetic
field strengths
Monitor: IPX1(Complies with the ingress
protection test specified in EN 60601-2-27
ECG Safety Standard.)
Remote: IPX0.
Power Supply: IPX2.

C-7

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Mechanical/Electrical
Power Supply

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Weight:
Operation:
Mechanical Shock:
Vibration:
Power Requirements:
Input Voltage:
Output Voltage:
Output Current:
Safety Standards:
EMC Standards:
Remote Display

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Size:

Size:
Weight:
Operation:
Mechanical Shock:
Vibration:
Power Requirements:
Voltage:
RF emissions:
Time to receive data
from patient monitor:
Safety Standards:
EMC Standards:

34.3 cm x 20.3 cm x 7.6 cm


13.5 inches x 8.0 inches x 3.0 inches
8.2 kg (18 lbs)
Continuous Use
Negligible effect up to 40G
Negligible effect up to 0.5G at 200Hz
400VA, typical
100-120, 220-240VAC; 50/60 Hz
16.5VDC
12.0A
UL60601-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 601.1-m90
IEC 60601-1
IEC 60601-1-2 2nd edition
CISPR 11, Class B
22.4 cm x 31.5 cm x 35.6 cm
8.8 inches x 12.4 inches x 14.0 inches
4.5 kg (10 lbs)
Continuous Use
Negligible effect up to 40G
Negligible effect up to 0.5G at 200Hz
45VA, typical
100-120, 220-240VAC; 50/60 Hz
Below 0dBV at 1 meter within 1MHz.
< 1 second
UL60601-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 601.1-m90
IEC 60601-1
IEC 60601-1-2 2nd edition
CISPR 11, Class B

C-8

Appendix C:Specifications

Main Monitor

Size:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Weight:
Operation:
Mechanical Shock:
Vibration:
Power Requirements:
Voltage:
Number of Batteries:
Battery Life:
Recharge time:

RF emissions:
Safety Standards:
EMC Standards:

Monitor Top Enclosure:


26.7 cm x 35.6 cm x 36.8 cm
(10.5 inches x 14 inches x 14.5 inches)
Main Monitor System (Depth/Width/Height at
Base):
50.5 cm x 58.4 cm x 188.7 cm
(19.9 inches x 23 inches x 74.3 inches)
Main Monitor System: 54.4 kg (120 lbs)
Monitor Top Enclosure only: 9.1 kg (20 lbs)
Continuous Use
Negligible effect up to 40G
Negligible effect up to 0.5G at 200Hz
400VA, typical
100-120, 220-240VAC; 50/60 Hz
2
Minimum of 10 hours on a fully charged
battery.
Approximately 12 hours, from a discharged
voltage of 10.6 volts to a charged voltage of
13.7 volts at ambient conditions (23C
2C).
Below 0dBV at 1 meter within 1MHz of
scanner center frequencies.
UL60601-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 601.1-m90
IEC 60601-1
IEC 60601-1-2 2nd edition
CISPR 11, Class B

All specifications are subject to change without notice.

C-9

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Appendix D: Accessories
MEDRAD
Part Number

Accessory Description
ECG Accessories
ECG Module

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

ECG Electrode Accessories

ECG Gating Accessories

ECG Module (complete with battery)

3010459

Fiber Optic ECG Cable, Duplex, 5m

3005290

ECG Lead set, 3 conductor


ECG Electrodes,3/strip, 1 Box, 30/box (10 sets)

3010461
3006324

ECG Lead set, 5 conductor


ECG Electrodes,5/strip, 1 Box, 50/Box (10 sets)

3010473
3010511

NuPrep,1 Tube

3006321

ECG Gating Cable, Phillips Intera

3010558

ECG Gating Cable, GE

3010475

ECG Gating Cable, Siemens Sonata/Symphony

3010559

ECG Gating Cable, Universal

3010477

Pulse Oximeter Probe, Adult, 2m

3010462

Pulse Oximeter Probe, Pediatric, 2m

3010794

Pulse Oximeter Probe, Neonatal, 2m

3010795

Pulse Oximeter Extension Cable, 3m

3010617

Neonate Tape

3011742

Pulse Oximeter Gating Cable, Philips

3010561

Pulse Oximeter Gating Cable, GE

3010562

Pulse Oximeter Gating Cable, Siemens

3010563

SpO2 Accessories
SpO2 Probes

SpO2 Peripheral
Gating Accessories

D-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

NIBP Accessories

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Reusable Cuffs

Blood Pressure Cuff, Adult, 25-35cm

3010466

Blood Pressure Cuff, Small Adult/Pediatric, 18-26cm

3010467

Blood Pressure Cuff, Large Arm, 33-47cm

3010469

Blood Pressure Cuff, Thigh, 44-66cm

3010470

NIBP Connection Tube, 5 meters

3010471

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, 3-6cm (1 box of 10)

3010520

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, 4-8cm (1 box of 10)

3010531

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, 6-11cm (1 box of 10)

3010532

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, 7-13cm (1 box of 10)

3010533

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, 8-15cm (1 box of 10)

3010534

Disp. Blood Pressure Cuff, Child, 10-19cm (1 box of 10)

3010468

IBP Accessories

IBP interface Cable, Baxter, 0.9m (3 feet)

3010479

Temperature Accessories

Skin Temperature Probe

3010515

Agent Accessories

Sample lines, 16 foot (1 box of 25)

3011468

Disposable Nasal Cannula (1 box of 10)

3010484

Divided Nasal Cannula (1 box of 10)

3010485

Pediatric Nasal Cannula (1 box of 10)

3011507

Pediatric Divided Nasal Cannula (1 box of 10)

3011508

WaterChek2+ Water Trap (1 box of 30)

3010487

Scavenging Adapter & Exhaust Line

3010962

O2 Sensor

3010970

CO2 Absorber

3010971

Disposable Cuffs

D-2

Appendix D:Accessories

Miscellaneous Accessories

Printer Paper - 5 rolls

3010961

AC to DC Power Supply (does not include DC or AC cables) 3010555

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Select one DC Power cable from the list below:


DC power Cable, 8 meters (25ft.)
DC power Cable, 15 meters (50ft.)

Select one AC Power cord from the list below:


AC power Cable, North American
535-0243-012
AC power Cable, International
535-0127-012
NOTE: A power cord is not offered that allows turn-key
compatiblity with Denmark outlets.
Fuse, Remote Display (1.0A/250V, Type T)

3012943

Fuse, Power Supply (4.0A/250V, Type T)

3012944

Veris 8600 Operation


Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation
Veris 8600 Operation

3010796
3011448
3011449
3011450
3011451
3011452
3011453
3011454
3011455
3010988

Publications
Operation Manuals

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

3010556
3010557

Help Cards

Installation and Service

Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards
Help Cards

Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual
Manual

- English
- Dutch
- French
- German
- Italian
- Japanese
- Portuguese
- Spanish
- Swedish
- Multi Language CD

English
Dutch
French
German
Italian
Japanese
Portuguese
Spanish
Swedish

3010797
3010991
3010992
3010993
3010994
3010995
3010996
3010997
3010998

Veris 8600 Patient Monitor Service Manual - English


Veris 8600 Remote Display Service Manual - English

3010798

Veris 8600 Patient Monitor Service Manual - English (CD)

3010990

Veris 8600 Patient Monitor Service Schematic


Manual - English (CD)

3010989

Installation Instructions

203035

D-3

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Appendix E: Troubleshooting
General Troubleshooting

Ensure proper placement of monitor and accessories in and


around the magnet bore.
Check the cables for fraying or other deterioration.
Check that all connections are secure.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Ensure that the batteries are charged in the main monitor and in
the ECG module.
Troubleshooting Table

This section lists the possible causes of monitor problems. Use this
table to identify and locate any causes for the malfunction.

Symptom

Problem

Solution

Main monitor wont


power up (On/Off LED
is dark)

Batteries are discharged

Connect monitor to the power supply


and recharge the batteries.

Remote display wont


power up (On/Off LED
is dark)

AC power cord is not


securely connected to
monitor
AC outlet off or unpowered
Fuses are blown (Located
above AC connection)

Connect AC power cord to wall


outlet

Display is blank or not


readable

Batteries are discharged

Connect monitor to the power supply


and recharge the batteries.
Connect AC power cord to the
remote display

AC power cord is not


securely connected to the
remote display

Connect power cord to a live outlet


Replace AC fuses

NIBP air leak

Defective cuff
Defective hose
Pneumatic tube leaks or
defective valve

Replace Cuff
Replace Hose
Contact MEDRAD Service
Department.

NIBP not functioning

NIBP is disconnected.
Software problem

Ensure NIBP cable and extension


cable are securely connected.
Contact MEDRAD Service Dept.

SpO2 not functioning

SpO2 cables are


disconnected.
Software problem

Ensure SpO2 cable and extension


cable are securely connected.
Contact MEDRAD Service Dept.

ECG noise or
intermittent function

Re-prep the patient


Reposition/replace electrodes
Replace fiber optic cable
Replace ECG module

Trap error or CO2


malfunction

Trap is plugged or leaks


O2 Cell is loose

Poor skin preparation


Poor electrode placement
Defective fiber optic cable
Defective ECG module

Replace trap
Tighten O2 Cell

E-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Symptom

Problem

Solution

O2 not responding
(CO2 functioning ok)

O2 Cell depleted

Replace O2 Cell

No sound from
speaker

Volume turned down

Set volume higher in Configuration


window.

COM 1 serial interface


doesnt work

Set to internal printer

Reset monitor to external printer

(Remote Display only)


Printer does not
automatically feed.

PAPER RELEASE lever in


released position
Paper may be jammed
Rollers may be worn

Lock PAPER RELEASE lever in the


horizontal position.
Clear any paper jam.
Use the MANUAL FEED knob.
Contact MEDRAD Service.

If the above Troubleshooting tips dont resolve the problem, see your
bio-medical personnel or contact MEDRADs Customer Service.

E-2

Appendix F: IBP Transducer


Specifications

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

IBP Specifications

Transducer Specifications

Invasive Blood Pressure


Channels:
Transducer Sites:
Pressure Range:
Excitation Voltage:
Transducer Sensitivity:
Resolution:
Accuracy:
Scale Range:

2
Selectable; ART, PA, LA, RA, CVP, ICP
-20mmHg to 300mmHg
5 volts ( 0.1 volt)
5V/V/mmHg
1 mmHg
1 mmHg or 1%, whichever is greater
-10 to 10, 0 to 20, 0 to 30, 0 to 40, 0 to 60,
0 to 100, 0 to 150, 0 to 200, 0 to 300,
and Auto Ranging

Transducer Impedance: > 300 ohms

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Transducer Sensitivity: 5 micro volts per volt per mmHg


Pressure Range: -20 mmHg to 300 mmHg

CAUTION !

Interface cables and adapters can introduce extra impedance as


well as inaccuracy due to poor connections. Consult with your
transducer manufacturer, before using additional accessories
with the Veris monitor.
Transducer Cables

Invasive blood pressure transducers are available with a variety of


cable and connection styles. Consult with your transducer provider for
specific transducers for use with MEDRAD, Inc., products.
Transducers that are specifically cable terminated for the Veris
monitor can be purchased through Fogg System Company, Inc. of
Denver, Colorado, www.foggsystem.com.

Compliance

As for all accessories, cables and transducers should comply with UL


and IEC standards for medical equipment.

Defibrillation Protection

The IBP module and port connection is defibrillation proof. Consult


your transducer supplier for information about defibrillation protection
of specific transducers and IBP fluid systems.

F-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

The Veris monitor does not employ any external, protective isolating
devices that are required to be used in conjunction with invasive
blood pressure monitoring accessories during high frequency
electrosurgery/electrocautery procedures. Use of invasive blood
pressure transducers with internal isolation between the electronic
bridge and the wetted parts is recommended for all IBP applications.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

High Frequency Interference

F-2

Appendix G: Fiber Optic


Communication
Fiber Optic Network
Communication Interface

The Veris 8600 fiber optic technology allows for hardwire


communication. The main monitor and remote display are connected
with a pair of fiber optic cables.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Operation
!

WARNING !

Do not take the remote display into the MR Scanner room. The
remote display contains ferromagnetic material and can be
strongly attracted to the magnet causing a safety hazard.
!

CAUTION !

Do not bend fiber optic cables too tightly. The communication


fiber optic cable should have a minimum bend radius of 11.3 cm
(4.5 inches).
The remote display is an option to the Veris Cardiac and Anesthesia
configurations.The remote display is standard on the Veris BasePlus
configuration. The remote display looks similar to the main monitor
that is in the MR room. The remote display must be in the control
room and communicate to the main monitor via a wireless or hardwire
serial connection. The remote display offers a way to control the Veris
main monitor from the control room without going into the MR room.
The remote display and main monitor are sychronized; what displays
on the main monitor displays on the remote display at the same time.
For example, if the user changes an alarm setting, both units display
the ALARMS menu and the change as it takes place.
When the remote display is turned on, it displays the message Please
Wait Until Synchronization until it synchronizes with the main monitor.
The main monitor sends its configuration, trend, and current screen
configuration data to the remote display. This causes the main
monitor and the remote display to be in the same state with the same
data.
NOTE: The remote display and main monitor cannot synchronize if
they are at different software revisions. If the main monitor and the
remote display cannot syncronize because the software revision is
different, then the remote display displays the message Remote and
Main have incompatible Software.

G-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

After the main monitor and the remote display synchronize, the
remote display mirrors what the main monitor is doing. The main
monitor is the master. An icon displays in the heart rate (HR)
parameter box, on both the remote display and the main monitor, to
show that the main monitor and the remote display are
communicating. (For more information on the heart rate parameter
box, go to ECG BOX on page 2-9.)
If communications are lost, the remote display displays the message
Please Wait Until Synchronization and the units cycle through the
synchronization process again after communications are restored.
The communication icon on the main monitor (in the heart rate
parameter box) does not display until communication is restored.
The remote display contains the internal printer. For more information
on printing, see Printing and Data Ports in Section 12.

G-2

Appendix H: Battery and Fuse


Specifications
Battery Specifications

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Main Monitor Batteries

NOTE: Batteries in the main monitor are not externally accesible.


Replacement of batteries must be done by a qualified service
technician and the unit must be tested afterwards. Refer to the
Service Manual for battery replacement.
Number of Batteries:
Type:
Voltage:
Amp-hour:
Battery Life:
Recharge time:

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Storage Time,
Shelf Life:

2
Sealed lead acid
12 Volt
17 amp-hour
Minimum of 10 hours on a fully charged battery.
Approximately 12 hours, from a discharged voltage of 10.6
volts to a charged voltage of 13.7 volts at ambient
conditions (23C 2C).
Charged battery, maximum 12 months with periodic
recharge at intervals specified by the manufactur

H-1

MEDRAD Veris 8600

Fuse Specifications

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

Remote Display Fuses

Main
Monitor
Fuses

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Power Supply Fuses

Number:
Type:
Amps:
Voltage:

2
T 1A L 250V
1 amp
250 volts

NOTE: Fuses in the main monitor are not externally accesible.


Replacement of fuses must be done by a qualified service technician
and the unit must be tested afterwards. Refer to the Service Manual
for fuse replacement. The fuses are found on the Main PCB:
F1: 3A Time Delay, carries 15mA
F2: 4A Time Delay, carries 3A peak
F3: 3A Time Delay, carries 15mA
F4: 1A Time Delay, circuit not used in Veris
F5: 5A Time Delay, carries 4.5A peak
F6: 4A Time Delay, carries 2.5A peak
Number:
Type:
Amps:
Voltage:

2
T 4A L 250V
4 amps
250 volts

NOTE: Fuses on the power supply board are not externally accesible.
Replacement of fuses must be done by a qualified service technician
and the unit must be tested afterwards. Refer to the Service Manual
for fuse replacement.
Number: 2
Type: H
Amps: 6.3 amps
Voltage: 250 volts

H-2

Appendix H:Battery and Fuse

Specifications

Fuse Removal/Replacement
Remote Display

There are two AC power fuses located at the rear of the remote
display directly above the AC power entry socket. See the fuse
specifications for the proper fuse.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

1. Press in the side clips (at the same time) with a tool and lift out
the small, black access cover. The two fuse sockets are visible.

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

Clips

Figure H-1: Remove the Fuse Cover

Figure H-2: Fuses Exposed

H-3

MEDRAD Veris 8600

This copy of 3010796 Rev 1 is valid as of Nov-04-2005 at 12:11:00. The signed original is maintained in
Documentation Systems. Prior to use, you are responsible to confirm this copy's revision is the latest released.

VIEWED/PRINTED:
11/08/2005 at 18:42:15.

2. Gently pull the fuses out of the fuse cover assembly.

Figure H-3: Fuses Pulled


3. Reassemble in reverse order.
Power Supply

There are two AC power fuses located at the AC input side of the
power supply directly above the AC power entry socket. See the fuse
specifications for the proper fuse.
1. Pry the cover from the fuse well above the AC cord.
2. Gently remove the fuse assembly and remove the spent fuse(s).
3. Replace fuses and reassemble in reverse order.

H-4

You might also like

pFad - Phonifier reborn

Pfad - The Proxy pFad of © 2024 Garber Painting. All rights reserved.

Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.


Alternative Proxies:

Alternative Proxy

pFad Proxy

pFad v3 Proxy

pFad v4 Proxy